2015 FIAT 500
2015
OWNER’S MANUAL
FCA US LLC
15FF500-126-AD
Fourth Edition Rev 1
Printed in U.S.A.
FIAT 500
VEHICLES SOLD IN CANADA
With respect to any Vehicles Sold in Canada, the name FCA
US LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name FCA
Canada Inc. used in substitution therefore.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunken driving is one of the most frequent causes of
accidents.
Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood
alcohol levels far below the legal minimum. If you are
drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated nondrinking driver, call a cab, a friend, or use public transportation.
This manual illustrates and describes the operation of
features and equipment that are either standard or optional on this vehicle. This manual may also include a
description of features and equipment that are no longer
available or were not ordered on this vehicle. Please
disregard any features and equipment described in this
manual that are not on this vehicle.
FCA US LLC reserves the right to make changes in design
and specifications, and/or make additions to or improvements to its products without imposing any obligation
upon itself to install them on products previously manufactured.
WARNING!
Driving after drinking can lead to an accident.
Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are
slower, and your judgment is impaired when you
have been drinking. Never drink and then drive.
Copyright © 2015 FCA US LLC
SECTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
1
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2
3
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
3
4
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4
5
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
5
6
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
6
7
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
7
8
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
8
9
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
9
10
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
10
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
䡵 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER . . . . . . . .7
䡵 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 䡵 VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS . . . .8
䡵 WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
1
4 INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
The enclosed Warranty Information lists the services that
FCA US LLC offers to its customers:
Congratulations on selecting your new vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision workmanship, distinc- • The Warranty Certificate with terms and conditions for
tive styling, and high quality - all essentials that are
maintaining its validity
traditional to our vehicles.
• The range of additional services available to FCA US
This Owner’s Manual has been prepared with the assisLLC customers
tance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it
you with the operation and maintenance of your vehicle.
should be stored in the vehicle for convenient referencIt is supplemented by Warranty Information, and various
ing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
customer-oriented documents. Please take the time to
read these publications carefully. Following the instruc- When it comes to service, remember that your authorized
tions and recommendations in this manual will help dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained techassure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
nicians and genuine parts, and cares about your satisfaction.
INTRODUCTION 5
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section
contains the information you desire.
Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the
items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and
illustrations may differ from your vehicle’s equipment.
The detailed index at the back of this Owner’s Manual
contains a complete listing of all subjects.
Consult the following table for a description of the
symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout
this Owner’s Manual:
1
6 INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION 7
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
1
This Owner’s Manual contains WARNINGS against
operating procedures that could result in a collision or
bodily injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures that could result in damage to your vehicle. If you
do not read this entire Owner’s Manual, you may miss
important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is found on the
left front corner of the instrument panel, visible through
the windshield. This number also appears engraved on
the right front door sill under the sill scuff plate, on an
adhesive label applied to the right door opening on the
B-Pillar, on the vehicle registration and title.
Vehicle Identification Number
8 INTRODUCTION
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle could
seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety and
may lead to a collision resulting in serious injury or
death.
Stamped VIN Location
NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2
CONTENTS
䡵 A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
▫ Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
▫ Locking Doors With A Key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
▫ Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
䡵 SENTRY KEY® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
▫ Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
䡵 REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ To Unlock The Doors And Liftgate . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ Remote Key Unlock, Driver Door/All Doors 1st
Press . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ Opening Power Top Remote Function . . . . . . .16
▫ To Lock The Doors And Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . .18
▫ Programming Additional Transmitters. . . . . . . .18
▫ Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .18
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
䡵 DOOR LOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
▫ Power Door Locks — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . .22
▫ Auto Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
䡵 POWER WINDOWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
▫ Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
▫ Power Window Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 䡵 ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS . . . .73
▫ Auto-Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 䡵 SAFETY TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
▫ Transporting Passengers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
䡵 LIFTGATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
▫ Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
䡵 OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS . . . . . . . . . .26
▫ Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
▫ Important Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
▫ Seat Belt Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
▫ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . . . . .39
▫ Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
▫ Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
The vehicle is supplied with a code card containing key
The key fob contains the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) code numbers to order duplicate keys, and the authotransmitter with an integrated key. To use the mechanical rized dealer that sold you your new vehicle has the key
code numbers for your vehicle locks. These numbers can
key, simply push the mechanical key release button.
be used to order duplicate keys.
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
Ignition Key Removal
1. Place the shift lever in PARK (if equipped with an
automatic transmission).
2. Rotate the key to the OFF/LOCK position.
3. Remove the key from the ignition switch lock cylinder.
Mechanical Key Release Button
2
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Ignition Switch Positions
1 — STOP (OFF/LOCK)
2 — MAR (ACC/ON/RUN)
3 — AVV (START)
• Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the parking
brake, shift the transmission into PARK and remove the Key Fob from the vehicle. When leaving
the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
Key-In-Ignition Reminder
Opening the driver’s door when the key is in the ignition
and the ignition switch position is OFF/LOCK sounds a
signal to remove the key.
SENTRY KEY®
CAUTION!
An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves. Always
remove the key from the ignition and lock all the
doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Locking Doors With A Key
You can insert the key with either side up. To lock the
door, turn the key to the left. To unlock the door, turn the
key to the right. Refer to “Body Lubrication” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for maintenance procedures.
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer System prevents unauthorized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation
is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked
or unlocked.
The system uses ignition keys which have an embedded
electronic chip (transponder) to prevent unauthorized
vehicle operation. Therefore, only keys that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate
the vehicle.
2
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: A key which has not been programmed is also Replacement Keys
considered an invalid key, even if it is cut to fit the
NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to the
ignition switch lock cylinder for that vehicle.
vehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Once
If the Vehicle Security Light is on after the key is turned a Sentry Key® has been programmed to a vehicle, it
to the ON/RUN position, it indicates that there is a cannot be programmed to any other vehicle. When having the Sentry Key® Immobilizer System serviced, bring
problem with the electronics.
all vehicle keys with you to an authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
• Always remove the Sentry Key® from the vehicle
and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
• The Sentry Key® Immobilizer system is not compatible with some aftermarket remote starting systems. Use of these systems may result in vehicle
starting problems and loss of security protection.
All of the keys provided with your new vehicle have
been programmed to the vehicle electronics.
The VIN is required for authorized dealer replacement of
keys. Duplication of keys may be performed at an
authorized dealer.
General Information
The Sentry Key® system complies with FCC rules part 15
and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is
subject to the following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
• This device must accept any interference that may be
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
EQUIPPED
This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors and
liftgate from distances up to approximately 66 ft (20 m)
using a hand-held Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitRemote Keyless Entry Transmitter
ter. The RKE transmitter does not need to be pointed at NOTE: The line of transmission must not be blocked
the vehicle to activate the system.
with metal objects.
2
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Unlock The Doors And Liftgate
Opening Power Top Remote Function
Push and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE The remote keyless power top function can only be used
transmitter once to unlock the driver’s door or twice, with the engine off.
within five seconds, to unlock all doors and the liftgate.
The turn signal lights will flash to acknowledge the
unlock signal. The illuminated entry system will also
turn on.
Remote Key Unlock, Driver Door/All Doors 1st
Press
This feature lets you program the system to unlock either
the driver’s door or all doors on the first push of the
UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter. To change the
current setting, refer to “Personal Settings (CustomerProgrammable Features)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
Key Fob
NOTE: The remote keyless power top function can be
used to open the power top to the spoiler position.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
Opening Power Top Remote Function:
WARNING! (Continued)
1. OPEN — Push and hold the unlock button down on
the key fob for a minimum of three seconds to initiate
Power Top Open. The roof will stop opening whenever the unlock button on the key fob is released, or
when it reaches the spoiler position
NOTE: If your power convertible top does not open with
the remote, please refer to the ⬙Power Convertible Top
Relearn Procedure” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle” for additional information.
WARNING!
Failure to follow these warnings can result in injuries
that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and
others around you:
• Before operating the power top, make sure that no
moving parts of the convertible top can injure a
person or animal.
(Continued)
• Never place any extremities (hands, feet, etc.) near
the convertible top components, the upper windshield area, the shelf area behind the rear seats, or
the convertible top stowage area while raising or
lowering the convertible top.
• When using the power top button on RKE transmitter, if potential danger exists while lowering the
top, release the button immediately to interrupt the
operation.
• Only drive the vehicle with the convertible top
completely closed and latched or fully lowered into
its stowage compartment.
• Do not operate the power top when the vehicle is in
motion.
2
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
1. Push the mechanical key release button and release the
mechanical key to access the battery case screw loPush and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitcated on the side of the Key Fob.
ter to lock all doors and the liftgate. The turn signal lights
will flash and the horn will chirp to acknowledge the
signal.
To Lock The Doors And Liftgate
Programming Additional Transmitters
Refer to “Sentry Key®” in “Things To Know Before
Starting” for further information.
If you do not have a programmed RKE transmitter,
contact your authorized dealer for details.
Transmitter Battery Replacement
NOTE: Perchlorate Material – special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate
The recommended replacement battery is CR2032.
Mechanical Key Release Button
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
2. Rotate the screw located on the side of the Key Fob 3. Take out the battery case. Remove and replace the
using a small screwdriver.
battery observing its polarity.
2
Key Fob Screw Location
Battery Case Removed
4. Refit the battery case inside the Key Fob and turn the
screw to lock it into place.
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
General Information
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate from a normal
distance, check for these two conditions:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the 1. A weak battery in the transmitter. The expected life of
following conditions:
the battery is a minimum of three years.
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station
tower, airport transmitter, and some mobile or CB
• This device must accept any interference received,
radios.
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
DOOR LOCKS
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved The door locks can be manually locked or unlocked from
by the party responsible for compliance could void the inside the vehicle by using the door handle. If the door
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
handle is pushed a red lock indicator will show on the
door handle (indicating locked) when the door is closed,
the door will lock.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
WARNING! (Continued)
Driver’s Door Lock Handle
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
(Continued)
• For personal security and safety in the event of a
collision, lock the vehicle doors as you drive as
well as when you park and leave the vehicle.
• Before exiting a vehicle, always turn the ignition to
the OFF/LOCK position, apply the parking brake,
shift the transmission into REVERSE gear, and
remove the Key Fob from the vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the gear selector.
(Continued)
2
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
NOTE: To prevent the key from being locked in the
vehicle, the doors will automatically unlock if the driver’s door handle is pushed when the key is in the
ignition.
CAUTION!
An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.
Always remove the key from the ignition and lock all
of the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Power Door Locks — If Equipped
A power door lock switch is incorporated into the driver
door handle. Push or pull the handle to lock or unlock the
doors and liftgate. If the driver’s door handle is pushed a red
lock indicator will show on the driver’s door handle (indicating locked) when the door is closed, the door will lock.
Driver’s Power Door Lock Handle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
3. Briefly push the MENU button to go back to the menu
screen, or push and hold the MENU button (approxiWhen enabled, the door locks will lock automatically
mately
one second) to go back to the main screen
when the vehicles speed exceeds 15 mph (24 km/h).
without storing the settings.
To change the setting proceed as follows:
NOTE: Use the Automatic Door Locks feature in accor1. Briefly push the MENU button to enter the MENU dance with local laws.
screen.
Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)”
or DOWN
button to highlight in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” in your Own2. Push the UP
“Auto Door Locks”. Push the MENU button, use er’s Manual on your DVD for further information.
or DOWN
buttons to turn setting ON
the UP
or OFF.
Auto Door Locks
2
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
POWER WINDOWS
Power Window Switches
There are single window controls located on the shifter
bezel, below the climate controls, which operate the
driver and passenger door windows. The window controls will operate when the ignition switch is in the
ON/RUN position.
WARNING!
Never leave children unattended in a vehicle, and do
not let children play with power windows. Do not
leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or in a
location accessible to children. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by
the windows while operating the power window
switches. Such entrapment may result in serious
injury or death.
Power Window Switches
Auto-Down
The driver’s door window switch has an Auto-Down
feature. Push the window switch for approximately one
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25
second, release, and the window will go down automati- To open the liftgate, squeeze the liftgate release handle
cally. To cancel the Auto-Down movement, operate the and pull the liftgate open with one fluid motion.
switch in either the up or down direction and release the
switch.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize
the buffeting or open any window.
LIFTGATE
To unlock the liftgate, use the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter or activate the power door lock
switches located on the driver door handle.
Liftgate Handle
2
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• Driving with the liftgate open can allow poisonous
exhaust gases into your vehicle. You and your
passengers could be injured by these fumes. Keep
the liftgate closed when you are operating the
vehicle.
• If you are required to drive with the liftgate open,
make sure that all windows are closed, and the
climate control blower switch is set at high speed.
Do not use the recirculation mode.
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
Some of the most important safety features in your
vehicle are the restraint systems:
• Seat Belt Systems
• Supplemental Restraint Systems (SRS) Air Bags
• Child Restraints
Important Safety Precautions
Please pay close attention to the information in this
section. It tells you how to use your restraint system
NOTE: Gas props support the liftgate in the open posi- properly, to keep you and your passengers as safe as
tion. However, because the gas pressure drops with possible.
temperature, it may be necessary to assist the props when
opening the liftgate in cold weather.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the 5. You should read the instructions provided with your
risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
child restraint to make sure that you are using it
properly.
1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride
6. All occupants should always wear their lap and
buckled up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
shoulder belts properly.
2. If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a rear-facing
child restraint) must ride in the front passenger seat, 7. The driver and front passenger seats should be moved
back as far as practical to allow the Advanced Front
move the seat as far back as possible and use the
proper child restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”)
Air Bags room to inflate.
3. Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle 8. Do not lean against the door or window. If your
vehicle has side air bags, and deployment occurs, the
seat belt properly (Refer to ⬙Child Restraints⬙) should
be secured in a vehicle with a rear seat in child
side air bags will inflate forcefully into the space
between occupants and the door and occupants could
restraints or belt-positioning booster seats. Older chilbe injured.
dren who do not use child restraints or beltpositioning booster seats should ride properly buckled
9. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be
up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
modified to accommodate a disabled person, contact
the Customer Center. Phone numbers are provided
4. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt behind
them or under their arm.
under ⬙If You Need Assistance.⬙
2
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should
be belted at all times.
Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
(BeltAlert)
BeltAlert is a feature intended to remind the driver
and outboard front passenger (if equipped with outboard front passenger BeltAlert) to buckle their seat
belts. The feature is active whenever the ignition
Seat Belt Systems
switch is in the START or ON/RUN position. If the
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even driver or outboard front seat passenger is unbelted,
on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver the Seat Belt Reminder Light will turn on and remain
and could cause a collision that includes you. This can on until both outboard front seat belts are buckled.
happen far away from home or on your own street.
The BeltAlert warning sequence begins after the vehicle
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they speed is over 5 mph (8 km/h) by blinking the Seat Belt
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some Reminder Light and sounding an intermittent chime.
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown Once the sequence starts, it will continue for the entire
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of duration or until the respective seat belts are buckled.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
After the sequence completes, the Seat Belt Reminder
Light remains illuminated until the respective seat belts
are buckled. The driver should instruct all other occupants to buckle their seat belts. If an outboard front seat
belt is unbuckled while traveling at speeds greater than
5 mph (8 km/h), BeltAlert will provide both audio and
visual notification.
The outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert is not active
when the outboard front passenger seat is unoccupied.
BeltAlert may be triggered when an animal or heavy
object is on the outboard front passenger seat or when the
seat is folded flat (if equipped). It is recommended that
pets be restrained in the rear seat (if equipped) in pet
harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts,
and cargo is properly stowed.
BeltAlert can be activated or deactivated by your authorized dealer. FCA US LLC does not recommend deactivating BeltAlert.
NOTE: If BeltAlert has been deactivated, the Seat Belt
Reminder Light will continue to illuminate while the
driver’s or outboard front passenger’s (if equipped with
BeltAlert) seat belt remains unbuckled.
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with
lap/shoulder belts.
The seat belt webbing retractor will lock only during very
sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the seat belt to move freely with you under
normal conditions. However, in a collision the seat belt
will lock and reduce your risk of striking the inside of the
vehicle or being thrown out of the vehicle.
2
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, the air bags won’t deploy at all.
Always wear your seat belt even though you have
air bags.
• In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer
much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
• Wearing your seat belt incorrectly could make your
injuries in a collision much worse. You might
suffer internal injuries, or you could even slide out
of the seat belt. Follow these instructions to wear
your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers
safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted into a single
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one
another in a collision, hurting one another badly.
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt for more
than one person, no matter what their size.
(Continued)
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of
injury in a collision. The seat belt forces won’t be at
the strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your
abdomen. Always wear the lap part of your seat
belt as low as possible and keep it snug.
• A twisted seat belt may not protect you properly. In
a collision, it could even cut into you. Be sure the
seat belt is flat against your body, without twists. If
you can’t straighten a seat belt in your vehicle, take
it to your authorized dealer immediately and have
it fixed.
• A seat belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle
will not protect you properly. The lap portion could
ride too high on your body, possibly causing internal injuries. Always buckle your seat belt into the
buckle nearest you.
• A seat belt that is too loose will not protect you
properly. In a sudden stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of injury. Wear
your seat belt snugly.
• A seat belt that is worn under your arm is dangerous.
Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck injury.
A seat belt worn under the arm can cause internal
injuries. Ribs aren’t as strong as shoulder bones. Wear
the seat belt over your shoulder so that your strongest
bones will take the force in a collision.
• A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect
you from injury during a collision. You are more
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt
are meant to be used together.
(Continued)
(Continued)
2
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• A frayed or torn seat belt could rip apart in a
collision and leave you with no protection. Inspect
the seat belt system periodically, checking for cuts,
frays, or loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify
the seat belt system. Seat belt assemblies must be
replaced after a collision.
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front
seat, and next to your arm in the rear seat (for vehicles
equipped with a rear seat). Grasp the latch plate and
pull out the seat belt. Slide the latch plate up the
webbing as far as necessary to allow the seat belt to go
around your lap.
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and
adjust the seat.
Pulling Out The Latch Plate
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33
3. When the seat belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”
plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug seat belt reduces
the risk of sliding under the seat belt in a collision.
2
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
Positioning The Lap Belt
4. Position the lap belt so that it is snug and lies low 5. Position the shoulder belt across the shoulder and
across your hips, below your abdomen. To remove
chest with minimal, if any slack so that it is comfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractor will
slack in the lap belt portion, pull up on the shoulder
withdraw any slack in the shoulder belt.
belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight, tilt the latch
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
6. To release the seat belt, push the red button on the 3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing.
The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of
buckle. The seat belt will automatically retract to its
the latch plate.
stowed position. If necessary, slide the latch plate
down the webbing to allow the seat belt to retract
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the
fully.
folded webbing and the seat belt is no longer twisted.
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
Seat Belt Extender
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/
If a seat belt is not long enough to fit properly, even when
shoulder belt.
the webbing is fully extended and the adjustable upper
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the shoulder belt anchorage (if equipped) is in its lowest
position, your authorized dealer can provide you with a
anchor point.
Seat Belt Extender. The Seat Belt Extender should be used
2. At about 6 to 12 inches (15 to 30 cm) above the latch
only if the existing seat belt is not long enough. When the
plate, grasp and twist the seat belt webbing 180
Seat Belt Extender is not required for a different occudegrees to create a fold that begins immediately above
pant, it must be removed.
the latch plate.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
WARNING!
• ONLY use a Seat Belt Extender if it is physically
required in order to properly fit the original seat
belt system. DO NOT USE the Seat Belt Extender
if, when worn, the distance between the front edge
of the Seat Belt Extender buckle and the center of
the occupant’s body is LESS than 6 inches.
• Using a Seat Belt Extender when not needed can
increase the risk of serious injury or death in a
collision. Only use the Seat Belt Extender when the
lap belt is not long enough and only use in the
recommended seating positions. Remove and store
the Seat Belt Extender when not needed.
Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the seat belt
across the thighs and as snug across the hips as possible.
Keep the seat belt low so that it does not come across the
abdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will take
the force if there is a collision.
Seat Belt Pretensioner
The front seat belt system is equipped with pretensioning
devices that are designed to remove slack from the seat
belt in the event of a collision. These devices may
improve the performance of the seat belt by removing
slack from the seat belt early in a collision. Pretensioners
work for all size occupants, including those in child
restraints.
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat
belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be
We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts worn snugly and positioned properly.
throughout their pregnancy. Keeping the mother safe is
the best way to keep the baby safe.
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
2
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Re- Restraints” section of this manual. The table below
straint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the preten- defines the type of feature for each seating position.
sioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or
a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.
Energy Management Feature
This vehicle has a seat belt system with an Energy
Management feature in the front seating positions that
may help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of
a collision. This seat belt system has a retractor assembly
that is designed to release webbing in a controlled
manner.
Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) —
If Equipped
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions may be
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per
equipped with a switchable Automatic Locking Retractor •
seating
position
(ALR) which is used to secure a child restraint system.
For additional information, refer to “Installing Child •
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt” under the “Child
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37
In Automatic Locking Mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre locked. The seat belt will still retract to
First Row
remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The Automatic
Second
Locking Mode is available on all passenger seating
Row
positions with a combination lap/shoulder belt. Use the
Automatic Locking Mode anytime a child restraint is
• N/A — Not Applicable
installed in a seating position that has a seat belt with this
• ALR — Automatic Locking Retractor
feature. Children 12 years old and under should always
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an be properly restrained in a vehicle with a rear seat.
ALR and is being used for normal usage, only pull the
WARNING!
seat belt webbing out far enough to comfortably wrap
around the occupant’s mid-section so as to not activate • Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you will hear a clicking
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
sound as the seat belt retracts. Allow the webbing to
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
retract completely in this case and then carefully pull out
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearonly the amount of webbing necessary to comfort- ably
facing child restraint.
wrap around the occupant’s mid-section. Slide the latch • Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
plate into the buckle until you hear a ⬙click.⬙
with a rear seat.
Driver
N/A
ALR
Center
N/A
N/A
Passenger
ALR
ALR
2
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode
1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until
the entire seat belt is extracted.
3. Allow the seat belt to retract. As the seat belt retracts,
you will hear a clicking sound. This indicates the seat
belt is now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it
to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking
Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency)
locking mode.
WARNING!
• The seat belt assembly must be replaced if the
switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) feature or any other seat belt function is not working
properly when checked according to the procedures in the Service Manual.
• Failure to replace the seat belt assembly could
increase the risk of injury in collisions.
• Do not use the Automatic Locking Mode to restrain
occupants who are wearing the seat belt or children
who are using booster seats. The locked mode is
only used to install rear-facing or forward-facing
child restraints that have a harness for restraining
the child.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
• Seat Belt Pretenioners
Air Bag System Components
• Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag • Seat Track Position Sensors
system components:
Advanced Front Air Bags
• Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the
driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat
• Air Bag Warning Light
belt restraint systems. The driver’s Advanced Front Air
• Steering Wheel and Column
Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The
• Instrument Panel
passenger’s Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the
instrument panel, above the glove compartment. The
• Knee Impact Bolsters
words “SRS AIRBAG” and “AIRBAG” are embossed on
• Advanced Front Air Bags
the air bag covers.
• Supplemental Side Air Bags
• Supplemental Knee Air Bag
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
2
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Advanced Front Air Bag And Knee Bolster Locations
1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags
2 — Passenger Knee Impact Bolster
3 — Supplemental Driver Side Knee Air Bag/Driver Knee Impact
Bolster
• Being too close to the steering wheel or instrument
panel during Advanced Front Air Bag deployment
could cause serious injury, including death. Air
bags need room to inflate. Sit back, comfortably
extending your arms to reach the steering wheel or
instrument panel.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
the driver or front passenger seat belt is buckled. The seat
belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the
The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage
Advanced Front Air Bags.
driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides
output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as
WARNING!
determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC),
which may receive information from the front impact • No objects should be placed over or near the air
sensors or other system components.
bag on the instrument panel or steering wheel,
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an
impact that requires air bag deployment. A low energy
output is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy
output is used for more severe collisions.
This vehicle may be equipped with driver and/or front
passenger seat track position sensors that may adjust the
inflation rate of the Advanced Front Air Bags based upon
seat position.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front
passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether
because any such objects could cause harm if the
vehicle is in a collision severe enough to cause the
air bags to inflate.
• Do not put anything on or around the air bag
covers or attempt to open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could be injured
because the air bags may no longer be functional.
The protective covers for the air bag cushions are
designed to open only when the air bags are
inflating.
(Continued)
2
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, air bags won’t deploy at all. Always wear your seat belts even though you have air
bags.
Advanced Front Air Bag Operation
Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide additional protection by supplementing the seat belts. Advanced Front Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk
of injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions. The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all frontal
collisions, including some that may produce substantial
vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions,
truck underrides, and angle offset collisions.
On the other hand, depending on the type and location of
impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a
severe initial deceleration.
Because air bag sensors measure vehicle deceleration
over time, vehicle speed and damage by themselves are
not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should
have deployed.
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all collisions, and also are needed to help keep you in position,
away from an inflating air bag.
When the ORC detects a collision requiring the Advanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large
quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the
Advanced Front Air Bags.
The steering wheel hub trim cover and the upper right
side of the instrument panel separate and fold out of the
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43
way as the air bags inflate to their full size. The Advanced
Front Air Bags fully inflate in less time than it takes to
blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while
helping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
This vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Driver
Knee Air Bag mounted in the instrument panel below the
steering column.
Knee Impact Bolsters
The Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag provides enThe Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of the hanced protection during a frontal impact by working
driver and front passenger, and position the front occu- together with the seat belts, pretensioners, and Advanced
pants for improved interaction with the Advanced Front Front Air Bags.
Air Bags.
Supplemental Side Air Bags
WARNING!
Your vehicle is equipped with two types of side air bags:
• Do not drill, cut, or tamper with the knee impact
bolsters in any way.
• Do not mount any accessories to the knee impact
bolsters such as alarm lights, stereos, citizen band
radios, etc.
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SABs):
Located in the outboard side of the front seats. The
SABs are marked with a “SRS AIRBAG” or “AIRBAG”
label sewn into the outboard side of the seats.
2
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
deploys through the seat seam into the space between the
occupant and the door. The SAB moves at a very high
speed and with such a high force that it could injure you
if you are not seated properly, or if items are positioned
in the area where the SAB inflates. Children are at an
even greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
WARNING!
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag Label
Do not use accessory seat covers or place objects
between you and the Side Air Bags; the performance
could be adversely affected and/or objects could be
pushed into you, causing serious injury.
The SABs may help to reduce the risk of occupant injury
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains
during certain side impacts, in addition to the injury
(SABICs): Located above the side windows. The trim
reduction potential provided by the seat belts and body
covering the SABICs is labeled “SRS AIRBAG” or
structure.
“AIRBAG.”
When the SAB deploys, it opens the seam on the outboard side of the seatback’s trim cover. The inflating SAB
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
The SABIC deploys downward, covering the side windows. An inflating SABIC pushes the outside edge of the
headliner out of the way and covers the window. The
SABICs inflate with enough force to injure you if you are
not belted and seated properly, or if items are positioned
in the area where the SABICs inflate. Children are at an
even greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
The SABICs may help reduce the risk of partial or
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side
windows in certain side impact events.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain (SABIC)
Label Location
SABICs may help reduce the risk of head injury to front
and rear seat outboard occupants in certain side impacts.
SABICs may reduce the risk of injuries in certain side
impacts, in addition to the injury reduction potential
provided by the seat belts and body structure.
WARNING!
• Your vehicle is equipped with left and right
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains
(SABICs). Do not stack luggage or other cargo up
high enough to block the deployment of the
(Continued)
2
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
SABICs. The trim covering above the side windows where the SABIC and its deployment path
are located should remain free from any obstructions.
• Your vehicle is equipped with SABICs. In order for
the SABICs to work as intended, do not install any
accessory items in your vehicle which could alter
the roof. Do not add an aftermarket sunroof to your
vehicle. Do not add roof racks that require permanent attachments (bolts or screws) for installation
on the vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof of the
vehicle for any reason.
appropriate, based on the severity and type of collision.
The side impact sensors aid the ORC in determining the
appropriate response to impact events. The system is
calibrated to deploy the Side Air Bags on the impact side
of the vehicle during impacts that require Side Air Bag
occupant protection. In side impacts, the Side Air Bags
deploy independently; a left side impact deploys the left
Side Air Bags only and a right-side impact deploys the
right Side Air Bags only. Vehicle damage by itself is not a
good indicator of whether or not Side Air Bags should
have deployed.
The Side Air Bags will not deploy in all side collisions,
including some collisions at certain angles, or some side
collisions that do not impact the area of the passenger
The SABICs and SABs (“Side Air Bags”) are designed to compartment. The Side Air Bags may deploy during
activate in certain side impacts. The Occupant Restraint angled or offset frontal collisions where the Advanced
Controller (“ORC”) determines whether the deployment Front Air Bags deploy.
of the Side Air Bags in a particular impact event is
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
Side Air Bags are a supplement to the seat belt restraint
system. Side Air Bags deploy in less time than it takes to
blink your eyes. Occupants, including children, who are
up against or very close to Side Air Bags can be seriously
injured or killed. Occupants, including children, should
never lean on or sleep against the door, side windows, or
area where the Side Air Bags inflate, even if they are in an
infant or child restraint.
WARNING!
• Side Air Bags need room to inflate. Do not lean
against the door or window. Sit upright in the
center of the seat.
• Being too close to the Side Air Bags during deployment could cause you to be severely injured or
killed.
• Relying on the Side Air Bags alone could lead to
more severe injuries in a collision. The Side Air
Bags work with your seat belt to restrain you
properly. In some collisions, Side Air Bags won’t
deploy at all. Always wear your seat belt even
though you have Side Air Bags.
Seat belts (and child restraints where appropriate) are
necessary for your protection in all collisions. They also
help keep you in position, away from inflating Side Air
Bags. To get the best protection from the Side Air Bags,
occupants must wear their seat belts properly and sit
upright with their backs against the seats. Children must
be properly restrained in a child restraint or booster seat NOTE: Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior
that is appropriate for the size of the child.
trim, but they will open during air bag deployment.
2
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like
particles. The particles are a normal by-product of the
The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate
process that generates the non-toxic gas used for air
immediately after deployment.
bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the
NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all
skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye
collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with
irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or
the air bag system.
throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation
continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on
If you do have a collision which deploys the air bags, any
your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer’s inor all of the following may occur:
structions for cleaning.
• The air bag material may sometimes cause abrasions
Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have deand/or skin reddening to the occupants as the air bags
ployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air
deploy and unfold. The abrasions are similar to fricbags will not be in place to protect you.
tion rope burns or those you might get sliding along a
carpet or gymnasium floor. They are not caused by
WARNING!
contact with chemicals. They are not permanent and
normally heal quickly. However, if you haven’t healed Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners cannot
significantly within a few days, or if you have any protect you in another collision. Have the air bags,
blistering, see your doctor immediately.
If A Deployment Occurs
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
WARNING! (Continued)
seat belt pretensioners, and the seat belt retractor
assemblies replaced by an authorized dealer immediately. Also, have the Occupant Restraint Controller
System serviced as well.
NOTE:
• Cut off fuel to the engine.
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or
until the ignition switch is turned to the “OFF” position.
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as
the battery has power or until the ignition switch is
turned to the “OFF” position.
• Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim,
• Unlock the doors automatically.
but they will open during air bag deployment.
System Reset Procedure
• After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an
Depending on the nature of the event the left and right
authorized dealer immediately.
turn signal lights, located in the instrument panel cluster,
Enhanced Accident Response System
may both be blinking and will continue to blink until the
In the event of an impact, if the communication network ignition switch is turned to the OFF position. In order to
remains intact, and the power remains intact, depending move your vehicle to the side of the road, you must
on the nature of the event, the ORC will determine follow the system reset procedure.
whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response System perform the following functions:
2
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Customer Action
1. Turn ignition OFF. (Turn Signal Switch Must be
placed in Neutral State).
2. Turn ignition ON.
3. Turn Right Turn Signal Switch ON.
4. Turn Left Turn Signal Switch ON.
5. Turn Right Turn Signal Switch ON.
6. Turn Left Turn Signal Switch ON.
7. Turn Left Turn Signal Switch OFF. (Turn Signal
Switch Must be placed in Neutral State).
8. Turn ignition OFF.
9. Turn Hazard Flashers OFF (Manually).
Customer Will See
Left Turn Light is OFF. Right Turn Light BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Left Turn Light is ON SOLID. Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Left Turn Light is ON SOLID. Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID.
Left Turn Light is OFF. Right Turn Light is OFF.
System is now reset and the engine may be started.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
If a reset procedure step is not completed within 45 The ORC contains a backup power supply system that
seconds, then the turn signal lights will turn off and the may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or
reset procedure must be performed again in order to be it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.
successful.
The ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning Light in the
instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds
Air Bag Warning Light
for a self-check when the ignition switch is first turned to
The air bags must be ready to inflate for your the ON/RUN position. After the self-check, the Air Bag
protection in a collision. The Occupant Re- Warning Light will turn off. If the ORC detects a malfunction in any part of the system, it turns on the Air Bag
straint Controller (ORC) monitors the internal
circuits and interconnecting wiring associated Warning Light, either momentarily or continuously. A
single chime will sound to alert you if the light comes on
with air bag system electrical components.
again after initial startup.
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of
the air bag system whenever the ignition switch is in the The ORC also includes diagnostics that will illuminate
START or ON/RUN position. If the ignition switch is in the instrument panel Air Bag Warning Light if a malfunction is detected that could affect the air bag system. The
the OFF position the air bag system is not on and the air
diagnostics also record the nature of the malfunction.
bags will not inflate.
While the air bag system is designed to be maintenance
2
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
free, if any of the following occurs, have an authorized
dealer service the air bag system immediately.
• The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during
the four to eight seconds when the ignition switch is
first turned to the ON/RUN position.
• The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to
eight-second interval.
• The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or
remains on while driving.
WARNING!
Ignoring the Air Bag Warning Light in your instrument panel could mean you won’t have the air bags
to protect you in a collision. If the light does not come
on as a bulb check when the ignition is first placed in
the on position, and stays on after you start the
vehicle, or if it comes on as you drive, have an
authorized dealer service the air bag system immediately.
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine Maintaining Your Air Bag System
related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint
WARNING!
Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. In this condition
the air bags may not be ready to inflate for your protec• Modifications to any part of the air bag system
tion. Have an authorized dealer service the air bag
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could
system immediately.
be injured if the air bag system is not there to
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
protect you. Do not modify the components or
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the
upper right side of the instrument panel. Do not
modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or running boards.
• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the air
bag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who
works on your vehicle that it has an air bag system.
• Do not attempt to modify any part of your air bag
system. The air bag may inflate accidentally or may
not function properly if modifications are made.
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat, including your
trim cover and cushion, needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or loosening/tightening of
(Continued)
seat attachment bolts), take the vehicle to your
authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved
seat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to
modify the air bag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
Event Data Recorder (EDR)
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder
(EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in
certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air
bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will
assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle
is designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating
2
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
were buckled/fastened
such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the
vehicle or the EDR.
accelerator and/or brake pedal
Child Restraints
• How fast the vehicle was traveling
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all
These data can help provide a better understanding of times, including babies and children.
the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
Every state in the United States, and every Canadian
NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a province, requires that small children ride in proper
non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by restraint systems. This is the law, and you can be prosthe EDR under normal driving conditions and no per- ecuted for ignoring it.
sonal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location)
are recorded. However, other parties, such as law en- Children 12 years or younger should ride properly
forcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in
the rear seats rather than in the front.
crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is
required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
WARNING!
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force required to
hold even an infant on your lap could become so
great that you could not hold the child, no matter
how strong you are. The child and others could be
badly injured. Any child riding in your vehicle
should be in a proper restraint for the child’s size.
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety
Standards. You should also make sure that you can install
it in the vehicle where you will use it.
NOTE:
• For
additional
information,
refer
to
www.seatcheck.org or call 1–866–SEATCHECK. Canadian residents should refer to Transport Canada’s
website for additional information:
There are different sizes and types of restraints for
children from newborn size to the child almost large • http://www.tc.gc.ca/eng/roadsafety/safedriverschildsafety-index-53.htm
enough for an adult safety belt. Always check the child
seat Owner’s Manual to make sure you have the correct
seat for your child. Carefully read and follow all the
instructions and warnings in the child restraint Owner’s
Manual and on all the labels attached to the child
restraint.
2
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Summary Of Recommendations For Restraining Children In Vehicles
Infants and
Toddlers
Small Children
Larger Children
Children Too Large
for Child Restraints
Child Size, Height, Weight Or Age
Children who are two years old or
younger and who have not reached the
height or weight limits of their child restraint
Children who are at least two years old or
who have out-grown the height or weight
limit of their rear-facing child restraint
Children who have out-grown their
forward-facing child restraint, but are too
small to properly fit the vehicle’s seat belt
Children 12 years old or younger, who
have out-grown the height or weight limit
of their booster seat
Recommended Type Of Child Restraint
Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible
Child Restraint, facing rearward in the rear
seat of the vehicle
Forward-Facing Child Restraint with a
five-point Harness, facing forward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Belt Positioning Booster Seat and the vehicle seat belt, seated in the rear seat of the
vehicle
Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear seat of
the vehicle
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
Infants And Child Restraints
Safety experts recommend that children ride rear-facing
in the vehicle until they are two years old or until they
reach either the height or weight limit of their rear-facing
child restraint. Two types of child restraints can be used
rear-facing: infant carriers and convertible child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rear-facing in the vehicle.
It is recommended for children from birth until they
reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used either rear-facing or
forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child seats
often have a higher weight limit in the rear-facing
direction than infant carriers do, so they can be used
rear-facing by children who have outgrown their infant
carrier but are still less than at least two years old.
Children should remain rear-facing until they reach the
highest weight or height allowed by their convertible
child seat.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
Older Children And Child Restraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown
their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forwardfacing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who
have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of
their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should
2
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for
as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height
allowed by the child seat.
All children whose weight or height is above the
forward-facing limit for the child seat should use a
belt-positioning booster seat until the vehicle’s seat belts
fit properly. If the child cannot sit with knees bent over
the vehicle’s seat cushion while the child’s back is against
the seatback, they should use a belt-positioning booster
seat. The child and belt-positioning booster seat are held
in the vehicle by the seat belt.
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to failure of an
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in a
collision. The child could be badly injured or
killed. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
directions exactly when installing an infant or
child restraint.
• After a child restraint is installed in the vehicle, do
not move the vehicle seat forward or rearward
because it can loosen the child restraint attachments. Remove the child restraint before adjusting
the vehicle seat position. When the vehicle seat has
been adjusted, reinstall the child restraint.
• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in
the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Do not leave it
loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident, it
could strike the occupants or seatbacks and cause
serious personal injury.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
Children Too Large For Booster Seats
5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend
over the front of the seat when their back is against the
seatback, should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this
simple 5-step test to decide whether the child can use the
vehicle’s seat belt alone:
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the
child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the
child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check seat belt fit
periodically and make sure the seat belt buckle is latched.
A child’s squirming or slouching can move the belt out of
position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck,
move the child closer to the center of the vehicle, or use
a booster seat to position the seat belt on the child
correctly.
1. Can the child sit all the way back against the back of
the vehicle seat?
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the front
of the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the
way back?
3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s shoulder
between their neck and arm?
4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching
the child’s thighs and not their stomach?
WARNING!
Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt under an
arm or behind their back. In a crash, the shoulder belt
will not protect a child properly, which may result in
serious injury or death. A child must always wear
both the lap and shoulder portions of the seat belt
correctly.
2
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Recommendations For Attaching Child Restraints
Restraint Type
Combined
Weight of the
Child + Child
Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Use any attachment method shown with an “X” Below
LATCH –
Seat Belt Only
LATCH –
Seat Belt + Top
Lower Anchors
Lower Anchors
Tether Anchor
Only
+ Top Tether
Anchor
X
X
X
X
X
X
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61
Lower Anchors And Tethers For Children (LATCH)
Restraint System
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Lower
Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system
has three vehicle anchor points for installing LATCHequipped child seats. There are two lower anchorages
located at the back of the seat cushion where it meets the
seatback and one top tether anchorage located behind the
seating position. These anchorages are used to install
LATCH-equipped child seats without using the vehicle’s
seat belts. Some seating positions may have a top tether
anchorage but no lower anchorages. In these seating
positions, the seat belt must be used with the top tether
anchorage to install the child restraint. Please see the
following table for more information.
2
62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
LATCH Positions For Installing Child Restraints In
This Vehicle
•
•
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per
seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
LATCH anchorage system to attach the child
restraint?
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat
belt be used together to attach a rearfacing or forward-facing child restraint?
Can two child restraints be attached using
a common lower LATCH anchorage?
No
No
Use the LATCH anchorage system until
the combined weight of the child and the
child restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the
seat belt and tether anchor instead of the
LATCH system once the combined weight
is more than 65 lbs (29.5 kg).
Do not use the seat belt when you use the
LATCH anchorage system to attach a rearfacing or forward-facing child restraint.
Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with
two or more child restraints. If the center
position does not have dedicated LATCH
lower anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child seat in the center position next
to a child seat using the LATCH anchorages in an outboard position.
2
64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch
the back of the front passenger seat?
Yes
Can the head restraints be removed?
Yes
The child seat may touch the back of the
front passenger seat if the child restraint
manufacturer also allows contact. See your
child restraint owner’s manual for more
information.
Yes, all may be removed
Locating LATCH Anchorages
The lower anchorages are round bars that are
found at the rear of the seat cushion where it
meets the seatback, below the anchorage symbols on the seatback. They are just visible when
you lean into the rear seat to install the child restraint.
You will easily feel them if you run your finger along the
gap between the seatback and seat cushion.
LATCH Anchorages
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
Locating Tether Anchorages
There are tether strap anchorages behind each
rear seating position located on the back of the
seat.
LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be
equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each side.
Each will have a hook or connector to attach to the lower
anchorage and a way to tighten the connection to the
anchorage. Forward-facing child restraints and some
rear-facing child restraints will also be equipped with a
tether strap. The tether strap will have a hook at the end
to attach to the top tether anchorage and a way to tighten
the strap after it is attached to the anchorage.
Center Seat LATCH
WARNING!
This vehicle does not have a center seating position.
Do not use the center lower LATCH anchorages to
install a child seat in the center of the back seat.
Always follow the directions of the child restraint manufacturer when installing your child restraint. Not all child
restraint systems will be installed as described here.
To Install A LATCH-Compatible Child Restraint
If the selected seating position has a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow the seat
belt, following the instructions below. See the section
“Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat Belt”
to check what type of seat belt each seating position has.
2
66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
1. Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and on the 4. If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect it to the
tether strap of the child seat so that you can more
top tether anchorage. See the section “Installing Child
Restraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for direceasily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicle
tions to attach a tether anchor.
anchorages.
2. Place the child seat between the lower anchorages for 5. Tighten all of the straps as you push the child restraint
rearward and downward into the seat. Remove slack
that seating position. For some second row seats, you
in the straps according to the child restraint manufacmay need to recline the seat and / or raise the head
restraint to get a better fit. If the rear seat can be moved
turer’s instructions.
forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to
6. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
move it to its rear-most position to make room for the
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
child seat. You may also move the front seat forward
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
to allow more room for the child seat.
in any direction.
3. Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the child
restraint to the lower anchorages in the selected seating position.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seat Belt:
When using the LATCH attaching system to install a
child restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not being
used by other occupants or being used to secure child
restraints. An unused belt could injure a child if they play
with it and accidentally lock the seat belt retractor. Before
installing a child restraint using the LATCH system,
buckle the seat belt behind the child restraint and out of
the child’s reach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with
the child restraint installation, instead of buckling it
behind the child restraint, route the seat belt through the
child restraint belt path and then buckle it. Do not lock
the seat belt. Remind all children in the vehicle that the
seat belts are not toys and that they should not play with
them.
WARNING!
• Improper installation of a child restraint to the
LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of the restraint. The child could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s directions
exactly when installing an infant or child restraint.
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads imposed by correctly-fitted
child restraints. Under no circumstances are they to
be used for adult seat belts, harnesses, or for
attaching other items or equipment to the vehicle.
2
68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt
Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems For Installing Child
Restraints In This Vehicle
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) that is designed to keep the lap portion of the seat
belt tight around the child restraint so that it is not
necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can be
“switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the
webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing
retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will
make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
into the retractor. Refer to the “Automatic Locking
Mode” description under “Occupant Restraints” for additional information on ALR.
• ALR = Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
•
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
What is the weight limit (child’s
weight + weight of the child restraint) for using the Tether Anchor
with the seat belt to attach a forward
facing child restraint?
Can the rear-facing child restraint
touch the back of the front passenger seat?
Weight limit of the Child Restraint
Can the head restraints be removed?
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to
tighten the seat belt against the belt
path of the child restraint?
Yes
Yes
No
Always use the tether anchor when
using the seat belt to install a forward facing child restraint, up to
the recommended weight limit of
the child restraint.
Contact between the front passenger seat and the child restraint is
allowed, if the child restraint
manufacturer also allows contact.
Yes, all may be removed
Do not twist the buckle stalk in a
seating position with an ALR retractor.
2
70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of
the belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing
out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract
1. Place the child seat in the center of the seating
back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you
position. For some second row seats, you may need to
will hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is
recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a
now in the Automatic Locking mode.
better fit. If the rear seat can be moved forward and
rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to move it to its 6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is
locked, you should not be able to pull out any webrear-most position to make room for the child seat.
You may also move the front seat forward to allow
bing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
more room for the child seat.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the
lap portion around the child restraint while you push
2. Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor
to pass it through the belt path of the child restraint.
the child restraint rearward and downward into the
vehicle seat.
Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
Installing A Child Restraint With A Switchable
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a 8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the
“click.”
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
4. Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight
against the child seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 71
strap. See the section “Installing Child Restraints
Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for directions to
attach a tether anchor.
9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
WARNING! (Continued)
tether strap of a rear-facing car seat to the tether
anchorage that is approved for that seating position,
located behind the top of the vehicle seat. See the
section “Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren
(LATCH) Restraint System” for the location of approved tether anchorages in your vehicle.
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether
Anchorage
WARNING!
Do not attach a tether strap for a rear-facing car seat
to any location in front of the car seat, including the
seat frame or a tether anchorage. Only attach the
(Continued)
1. Look behind the seating position where you plan to
install the child restraint to find the tether anchorage.
You may need to move the seat forward to provide
better access to the tether anchorage. If there is no top
2
72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
tether anchorage for that seating position, move the
child restraint to another position in the vehicle if one
is available.
2. Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path
for the strap between the anchor and the child seat. If
your vehicle is equipped with adjustable rear head
restraints, raise the head restraint, and where possible,
route the tether strap under the head restraint and
between the two posts. If not possible, lower the head
restraint and pass the tether strap around the outboard
side of the head restraint.
Rear Seat Tether Strap Mounting
3. Attach the tether strap hook of the child restraint to
4. Remove slack in the tether strap according to the child
the top tether anchorage as shown in the diagram.
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73
WARNING!
• An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead to
increased head motion and possible injury to the
child. Use only the anchorage position directly
behind the child seat to secure a child restraint top
tether strap.
• If your vehicle is equipped with a split rear seat,
make sure the tether strap does not slip into the
opening between the seatbacks as you remove
slack in the strap.
Transporting Pets
Air Bags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet.
An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly
injured, or could injure a passenger during panic braking
or in a collision.
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses
or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS
A long break-in period is not required for the engine and
drivetrain (transmission and axle) in your vehicle.
Drive moderately during the first 300 miles (500 km).
After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speeds up to 50 or
55 mph (80 or 90 km/h) are desirable.
While cruising, brief full-throttle acceleration within the
limits of local traffic laws contributes to a good break-in.
Wide-open throttle acceleration in low gear can be detrimental and should be avoided.
The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is a
high-quality energy conserving type lubricant. Oil
changes should be consistent with anticipated climate
conditions under which vehicle operations will occur. For
the recommended viscosity and quality grades, refer to
“Maintenance Procedures” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle.”
2
74 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
WARNING!
Never use Non-Detergent Oil or Straight Mineral Oil
in the engine or damage may result.
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
NOTE: A new engine may consume some oil during its
first few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This
should be considered a normal part of the break-in and
not interpreted as a problem.
SAFETY TIPS
Transporting Passengers
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
AREA.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 75
Exhaust Gas
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon
monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless.
Breathing it can make you unconscious and can
eventually poison you. To avoid breathing (CO),
follow these safety tips:
• Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in
confined areas any longer than needed to move
your vehicle in or out of the area.
• If you are required to drive with the trunk/liftgate/
rear doors open, make sure that all windows are
closed and the climate control BLOWER switch is
set at high speed. DO NOT use the recirculation
mode.
(Continued)
• If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running, adjust your heating or cooling
controls to force outside air into the vehicle. Set the
blower at high speed.
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust
system, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the
vehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is
damaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken,
damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open
seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes
to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition,
inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
2
76 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle
Seat Belts
not lit during starting, see your authorized dealer. If the
light stays on, flickers, or comes on while driving, have
the system checked by an authorized dealer.
Inspect the seat belt system periodically, checking for
cuts, frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be
replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the
system.
Defroster
Air Bag Warning Light
unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that they
cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals
or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.
Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place
the blower control on high speed. You should be able to
feel the air directed against the windshield. See your
authorized dealer for service if your defroster is inoperFront seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a
able.
collision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after
a collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, Floor Mat Safety Information
torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding seat Always use floor mats designed to fit the footwell of your
belt or retractor condition, replace the seat belt.
vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal area
The light should come on and remain on for
four to eight seconds as a bulb check when the
ignition switch is first turned ON. If the light is
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 77
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of
vehicle control and increase the risk of serious personal injury.
• Always make sure that floor mats are properly
attached to the floor mat fasteners.
• Never place or install floor mats or other floor
coverings in the vehicle that cannot be properly
secured to prevent them from moving and interfering with the pedals or the ability to control the
vehicle.
• Never put floor mats or other floor coverings on top
of already installed floor mats. Additional floor
mats and other coverings will reduce the size of the
pedal area and interfere with the pedals.
• Check mounting of mats on a regular basis. Always
properly reinstall and secure floor mats that have
been removed for cleaning.
• Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the
driver footwell while the vehicle is moving. Objects can become trapped under the brake pedal
and accelerator pedal causing a loss of vehicle
control.
• If required, mounting posts must be properly installed, if not equipped from the factory.
Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or
mounting can cause interference with the brake
pedal and accelerator pedal operation causing loss of
control of the vehicle.
(Continued)
2
78 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle
Door Latches
Tires
Fluid Leaks
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects
lodged in the tread or sidewall. Inspect the tread for cuts
and cracks. Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks and bulges.
Check the wheel bolts for tightness. Check the tires
(including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel,
engine coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline
fumes are detected or if fuel, power steering fluid (if
equipped), or brake fluid leaks are suspected. The cause
should be located and corrected immediately.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and
exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn
signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument
panel.
Check for proper closing, latching, and locking.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 POWER CONVERTIBLE TOP — IF EQUIPPED . .82
▫ Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . .89
▫ Lowering The Power Top. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
▫ Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
▫ Raising The Power Top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 䡵 BLUE&ME™ HANDS-FREE COMMUNICATION . .90
▫ Power Convertible Top Relearn Procedure . . . . .84
▫ Wind Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
䡵 MIRRORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
▫ Inside Day/Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
▫ Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . .86
▫ Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
▫ Folding Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
▫ Blue&Me™ Hands-Free Communication Overview
— If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
▫ The Hands-Free Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
䡵 SEATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
▫ Forward/Rearward Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . .98
▫ Recline Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
▫ Seat Height Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
3
80 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ EZ Entry Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
▫ Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Memory Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
▫ Follow Me Home/Headlight Delay . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Heated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
▫ Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
▫ Front Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .111
䡵 TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD . . . . . . . . .104 䡵 WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . .111
䡵 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
▫ Front Windshield Wiper Operation . . . . . . . . .112
▫ Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
▫ Rear Windshield Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
▫ Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
䡵 TILT STEERING COLUMN — IF EQUIPPED . . .115
▫ High Beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
䡵 ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . .116
▫ Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
▫ Parking Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
▫ To Set A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
▫ Daytime Running Lights — If Equipped . . . . .108
▫ To Deactivate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
▫ To Resume Speed. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 81
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
▫ Pinch Protect Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
▫ To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
䡵 REAR PARK ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .120
▫ Emergency Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
▫ Rear Park Assist Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
▫ Sun Shade — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
▫ Rear Park Assist Warning Display . . . . . . . . . .121 䡵 ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS . . . . . . . . . . .128
▫ Rear Park Assist Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 䡵 CIGAR LIGHTER — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . .131
▫ Rear Park Assist Audible Alerts . . . . . . . . . . .121 䡵 CUPHOLDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
▫ Failure Indications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 䡵 STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
▫ Cleaning The Rear Park Assist System . . . . . . .123
▫ Glove Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
▫ Park Assist System Usage Precautions . . . . . . .124 䡵 CARGO AREA FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
䡵 POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .126 䡵 REAR WINDOW FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
▫ To Open . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
▫ To Close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
▫ Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
3
82 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
POWER CONVERTIBLE TOP — IF EQUIPPED
NOTE:
On vehicles equipped with a power convertible top, the • The power top buttons will operate when the ignition
power convertible top switch is located on the overhead
switch is turned to the ACC/ON/RUN position.
console. The switch contains two buttons. The passenger
side button, is used to open the power top, and the driver • The power top can be remotely operated with the key
fob. Refer to “Opening Power Top Remote Function”
side button, is used to close the power top.
in “Things To Know Before Starting” for more information.
Lowering The Power Top
Auto Open
Push the top open button approximately one second for
the three-quarter open/spoiler position. Push the top
open button for approximately one second a second time
to fully open the convertible top.
Manual Open
Power Convertible Top Switch
For manual open, push and hold the open button until
desired roof position or until spoiler position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 83
NOTE: Vertical movement only operates in auto open/ NOTE: Rail lubrication is recommended every 2000
cycles, or if scratching noises due to dust are present.
close mode.
Refer to “Fluids, Lubes, and Genuine Part” in “MaintainRaising The Power Top
ing Your Vehicle” for information.
Auto Close
From the convertible top fully open position, push the
top close button for approximately one second for the
three-quarter open/spoiler position. Push the top close
button for approximately one second a second time for
the one-quarter open position. Push and hold close
button to fully close convertible top.
Manual Close
For manual close, push and hold the close button until
desired position until one-quarter open position. Push
and hold again for full close position.
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions may cause interior
water damage, stains or mildew on the top material:
• Avoid high-pressure car washes, as they can damage the top material. Also, increased water pressure
may force water past the weather strips.
• Remove any standing water from the top and dry
the surface before opening it. Operating the top,
opening a door or lowering a window while the top
is wet may allow water to drip into the vehicle’s
interior.
3
84 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Use care when washing the vehicle, water pressure
directed at the weather strip seals may cause water
to leak into the vehicle’s interior.
WARNING!
The convertible top does not provide the structural
protection that a reinforced metal roof does and the
fabric top cannot be expected to prevent the ejection
of the occupants in a collision. Therefore, it is important that all occupants wear their seat belts at all
times. Death or serious injuries could occur if you are
ejected from the vehicle during a collision.
Power Convertible Top Relearn Procedure
If your power convertible top does not operate in the
Auto Opening/Closing mode (automatically opening/
closing to the one-quarter open and three-quarter open
comfort stops), or if the remote keyless power top
function is inoperable, or if the trunk lid does not open the following relearn procedure may be necessary.
1. Confirm that the door/trunk lid are closed.
2. Begin with the top in the fully closed position (using
manual mode).
3. Hold the OPEN button to move the top to the fully
open position.
4. CONTINUE to hold the OPEN button for an additional three seconds.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 85
5. Release the OPEN button.
NOTE: DO NOT interrupt this activity.
6. Hold the CLOSED button to move the top to the fully If the power convertible top does not relearn repeat the
procedure a second time.
closed position.
7. CONTINUE to hold the CLOSED button until the top Wind Stop
begins to cycle fully open, then release the CLOSED The Wind Stop installs in the backseat area of the vehicle.
button.
The Wind Stop will not interfere with power top operaAt the end of step 7 the top will automatically cycle to the tion. Therefore, it can remain installed when the top is up.
fully open position, and then close to the 1/4 open
MIRRORS
position.
This will confirm that the relearn procedure was success- Inside Day/Night Mirror
ful.
The mirror can be adjusted up, down, left, and right for
Auto Open/Close will now be functional. Trunk lid various drivers. The mirror should be adjusted to center
operation will be functional. Remote Keyless Power Top on the view through the rear window.
Function will be functional.
Headlight glare from vehicles behind you can be reduced
by moving the small control under the mirror to the night
3
86 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
position (toward the rear of the vehicle). The mirror Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
should be adjusted while set in the day position (toward This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare
the windshield).
from vehicles behind you. You can turn the feature on or
off by pushing the button at the base of the mirror. A light
to the left of the button will illuminate to indicate when
the dimming feature is activated. The sensor to the right
of the button does not illuminate.
NOTE: This feature is disabled when the vehicle is
moving in reverse.
Adjusting Rearview Mirror
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 87
Power Mirrors
The power mirror controls are located on the driver’s
door trim panel.
3
Automatic Dimming Mirror
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning, never
spray any cleaning solution directly onto the mirror.
Apply the solution onto a clean cloth and wipe the
mirror clean.
Power Mirror Switches
88 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The power mirror controls consist of a mirror select
switch and a four-way mirror control switch. To adjust a
mirror, push the mirror select switch to either the L (left)
or R (right) to select the mirror you need to adjust.
Spotter Mirror — If Equipped
Some models are equipped with a driver’s side spotter
mirror. The spotter mirror allows for a greater range of
visibility on the driver’s side of the vehicle.
Using the mirror control switch, push on any of the four
arrows for the direction that you want the mirror to
move.
WARNING!
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away
than they really are. Relying too much on your
passenger side mirror could cause you to collide with
another vehicle or other object. Use your inside
mirror when judging the size or distance of a vehicle
seen in the passenger side convex mirror.
Spotter Mirror
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 89
Folding Mirrors
Sun Visors
The exterior mirrors are hinged to allow the mirror to
pivot forward or rearward to help avoid damage. The
mirror has three detent positions: full forward, normal
and full rearward.
The driver and passenger sun visors are located on the
headliner, near the front windshield. The sun visor can be
rotated downward or up against the door glass. Both sun
visors are equipped with courtesy mirrors.
Heated Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice. This
feature can be activated whenever you turn on the
rear window defroster (if equipped). Refer to “Rear
Window Features” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle” for further information.
Sun Visor (Passenger Side Shown)
3
90 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
you are not required to train the voice recognition system
to recognize your voice. This implies that the system is
Blue&Me™ Hands-Free Communication Overview
nearly equally performing with different persons, i.e.: the
— If Equipped
voice recognition system is of the “speaker independent”
Windows Mobile™-based FIAT BLUE&ME™ is a per- type.
sonal telematic system enabling you to use communicaWith this system you can also play your favorite music
tion and entertainment applications expressly designed
stored on USB device and select tracks and playback
for use in the car.
modes with both voice commands or buttons on the
The BLUE&ME™ system installed on your car is steering wheel.
equipped with a hands-free kit, message reader and
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules
media player, and it is preset for future installation of
subject to the following two conditions:
additional services.
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
The BLUE&ME™ system, fully integrated with voice
commands, buttons on the steering wheel and multifunc- • This device must accept all interference received, intion display messages, gives you the possibility of intercluding interference that may cause undesired operaacting with your Bluetooth® wireless technology mobile
tion.
phone (even if you keep it in your pocket or bag) without
having to take your eyes off the road or remove your
hands from the steering wheel. To use voice commands
BLUE&ME™ HANDS-FREE COMMUNICATION
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 91
steering wheel controls and the instrument panel multifunction display. Please refer to the Fiat Blue & Me Radio
The basic characteristic of this hands-free kit is voice
Supplement for further information.
recognition with Bluetooth® wireless technology. With
this system you can make and receive calls safely and
securely by using either voice commands or buttons on
the steering wheel. This can be done under any driving
condition without ever having to take your eyes off the
road or remove your hands from the steering wheel, as
required by current laws.
The Hands-Free Kit
Bluetooth® wireless technology enables wireless connection between your mobile phone and the hands-free kit
installed on your car.
To use the hands-free kit, you need a Bluetooth® wireless
technology enabled mobile phone. This hands-free kit
Steering Wheel Hands Free Buttons
gives you the possibility of interacting vocally with your
mobile phone while driving, even if your mobile device 1 — Mute/ESC
3 — Phone Hang Up
4 — Voice Recognition (VR)
does not feature Voice Recognition. You can also interact 2 — Phone/Main
with your mobile phone manually and visually using the
3
92 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To get started with BLUE&ME™ hands-free kit with • To interact with BLUE&ME™ you can use either the
voice recognition, you have to simply pair your
buttons on the steering wheel or voice commands.
With voice recognition, you can perform system funcBluetooth® wireless technology enabled mobile phone
tions by speaking voice commands, also identified as
with the system.
“keywords”. When the system recognizes a keyword,
Pairing is an operation that has to be made only once.
it will respond with the appropriate action. Voice
NOTE:
recognition is an easy and convenient way to use
BLUE&ME™.
• During the mobile phone pairing procedure,
BLUE&ME™ attempts to detect a phone equipped All the system functions are available within the
with Bluetooth® wireless technology within range and BLUE&ME™ Main Menu. When the car is not moving,
then establishes the connection using a Personal Iden- you can scroll through the complete menu by using either
the buttons on the steering wheel or the voice commands.
tification Number (PIN).
When you are traveling, you can interact with
• Once your phone is paired, you have the option to
BLUE&ME™ by using the buttons on the steering wheel
transfer your mobile phone contacts to the hands-free
or voice commands relevant only to phone functions
kit, to make a phone call either by using the contacts
(LAST CALLS and PHONEBOOK) and the media player.
list or directly pronouncing the phone number, to
To activate settings when travelling you can only use
answer a call and also to answer another incoming
voice commands.
phone call.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 93
• Conference Call — You can call another contact while
you are engaged in a phone conversation (with
Contact Calling By Voice — You can call a contact in
Bluetooth® phones supporting this option).
your mobile phone phonebook using your voice. You
can also call a contact in your phonebook by scanning • Call Waiting — While engaged in a phone conversathrough the entries on the multifunction display. (To
tion, you can receive notification of another incoming
use this option you have to transfer your mobile phone
phone call, answer the other incoming phone call, and
contacts to the hands-free kit phonebook).
switch between two ongoing phone conversations.
(Call waiting is only supported by a subset of compatDigit Dialing By Voice — You can dial a phone
ible mobile phones).
number by pushing the VR button on the steering
wheel and speaking the digits to be dialed.
• Refusing Incoming Call Or Ending A Call — You can
refuse an incoming call or end a current call by
To Call The SMS Text Sender — Call directly the last
pushing the Phone Hang-up button on the steering
SMS text sender or the sender of a message received
wheel.
and stored in the BLUE&ME™ inbox.
After pairing and connecting your phone with the
To Answer A Call — You can answer an incoming call BLUE&ME™ system, you can make phone calls by
by pushing the MAIN/Phone button on the steering speaking keywords or pushing buttons on the steering
wheel.
The hands-free kit enables the following operations:
•
•
•
•
3
94 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
wheel. When using the hands-free phone, the audio Message reader functions are managed by the control
output of a phone conversation is heard through your car buttons on the steering wheel or by the BLUE&ME™
voice commands.
sound speakers.
Message Reader
The BLUE&ME™ message reader enables the following
operations:
The BLUE&ME™ message reader enables automatic
reading, through the car sound system, of the SMS texts • To display an indicator on the instrument panel that
you receive on your Bluetooth® wireless technology
indicates you have received a new SMS text. It will
mobile phone that are received when the phone is paired
display the sender’s number/name and will ask you
and connected to the BLUE&ME™ system. It does not
whether to read the text of the message to you.
provide access to messages that were received before the
device was connected with the BLUE&ME™ system. The • To manage the list of SMS texts received on your
message reader will also interpret many abbreviations
BLUE&ME™ paired mobile phone.
and emoticons contained in the SMS text.
• To read the messages received and stored. Messages
NOTE: Not all mobile phones support the SMS text
can be read multiple times.
message reader function or automatic phonebook transfer via Bluetooth®. For further information on the list of • To call the SMS text sender using the buttons on the
steering wheel or voice commands.
compatible
mobile
phones
go
to
http://
www.fiatusa.com, find the SUPPORT section near the
bottom of web page and click on the Bluetooth® logo.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 95
• To delete individual messages or the entire inbox using • iPod® Player — See dedicated paragraph under Media Player Functions.
the buttons on the steering wheel or voice commands.
The media player enables the following operations:
The BLUE&ME™ system can also recognize and read
• Digital Audio Playback — You can play all your
abbreviations, if any (e.g. “ILUVU” will be read like “I
digital audio files (.mp3, .wma, .wav, .aac) or play a
love you”) and interpret the most usual emoticons (e.g. :-)
customized playlist (.m3u or .wpl format).
will be read like “Smile”), that are currently used to write
• Audio File Selection By Category — You can play all
SMS texts.
audio files of a certain category, e.g.: album, artist or
Media Player
genre.
With the BLUE&ME™ media player you can play the
digital audio files stored on a USB device by simply • Playback Options — While playing tracks you can
select the following options: Play, Stop, Next track,
connecting it to the USB port located in the center console
Previous track, Shuffle and Loop track.
of the car. A second USB port, used for charging only, is
located in the glovebox.
In this way, while you are driving you can play your
favorite music collections.
3
96 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
• The media player does not support audio files compressed with other formats and DRM (Digital Rights
Management) protected audio files. Non-supported
audio files that may be present on the USB device will
be ignored.
• To use the media player, you have to simply connect
(directly or by an extension lead) your USB device to
the center console USB port. After turning the ignition
key to ON, BLUE&ME™ will start building your
media library. At the end of this operation you can surf
the complete library and scroll its categories as required using the buttons on the steering wheel or voice
commands. BLUE&ME™ will then play your selection
via the car sound system.
WARNING!
• Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle control, accident and injury. It is strongly
recommended that you use extreme caution when
using any device or feature that may take your
focus off the road or your hands off the steering
wheel. Your primary responsibility is the safe operation of your vehicle.
• The use of any handheld device while driving is
not recommended. Use voice-operated systems
when possible. Follow all applicable laws that may
affect the use of electronic devices while driving.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 97
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Keep the Owner’s Manual in the car: when kept in
the car, the Owner’s Manual will be available for
you and other users unfamiliar with the system.
Please make certain that before using the system
for the first time, all persons have access to the
Owner’s Manual and read its instructions and
safety information carefully.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
SEATS
Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the
vehicle.
3
98 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Forward/Rearward Adjustment
The adjusting bar is located at the front of the seats, near
the floor.
move forward and rearward on the seat to be sure that
the seat adjusters have latched.
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
Recline Adjustment
The recline adjustment lever is located on the inboard
side of the seat. To recline the seatback, lift up the recline
While sitting in the seat, lift up on the bar and move the lever, lean back until the desired position has been
seat forward or rearward. Release the bar once the reached, and release the lever.
desired position is reached. Then, using body pressure,
Adjusting Bar
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 99
Seat Height Adjustment
The driver’s seat height can be raised or lowered by
using a lever, located on the outboard side of the seat.
Pump the lever upward to raise the seat height, or pump
the lever downward to lower the seat height.
Recline Lever
WARNING!
Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
Height Adjuster
3
100 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Lift the seatback upright and push the seat rearward to
The driver and front passenger seats have an EZ entry its locked position once the rear passengers are seated.
feature for rear seat passengers. Pull forward on the Memory Feature
release lever, located on the outboard side of the seatback,
Both front seats have a memory feature, which can
dump the seatback forward, then slide the seat forward
operate in two ways:
to allow access in and out of the rear seat.
Memory Function Option 1 — Full Seat Back And
Track Fore/Aft Position Memory:
EZ Entry Feature
After using the EZ entry function, the seatback angle and
the Track fore/aft adjuster can both re-lock into the
position they were most recently adjusted to. This is
accomplished if the seat is moved fully rearward to its
last fore/aft position on the tracks before the seat back is
returned upright.
Memory Function Option 2 — Seat Back Only
Memory:
EZ Entry Lever
After using the EZ entry function, the seat back may first
be returned upright prior to going back to the last
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 101
fore/aft (memory) position on the tracks. This results in
the seat back memory being set only – The track will then
be locked forward of its last set fore/aft memory position. To then reset the fore/aft track memory feature (to
reestablish Memory Function Option 1), the seat has to be
returned fully rearward to its last fore/aft memory track
position as described in Memory Function Option 1.
Heated Seats — If Equipped
On some models, the front driver and passenger seats
may be equipped with heaters in both the seat cushions
and seatbacks. The controls for the front heated seats are
located on the center instrument panel area.
Push the switch once to turn on the heated
seats. Push the switch a second time to shut the
heating elements off.
NOTE: Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt
within two to five minutes.
WARNING!
• Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion or other physical condition must exercise care
when using the seat heater. It may cause burns
even at low temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
• Do not place anything on the seat or seatback that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion.
This may cause the seat heater to overheat. Sitting
in a seat that has been overheated could cause
serious burns due to the increased surface temperature of the seat.
3
102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Head Restraints
Reactive Head Restraints — Front Seats
Head restraints are designed to reduce the risk of injury
by restricting head movement in the event of a rearimpact. Head restraints should be adjusted so that the top
of the head restraint is located above the top of your ear.
The front driver and passenger seats are equipped with
Reactive Head Restraints. In the event of a rear impact
the Reactive Head Restraints will automatically extend
forward minimizing the gap between the back of the
occupant’s head and the Reactive Head Restraint.
WARNING!
The head restraints for all occupants must be properly adjusted prior to operating the vehicle or occupying a seat. Head restraints should never be adjusted while the vehicle is in motion. Driving a
vehicle with the head restraints improperly adjusted
or removed could cause serious injury or death in the
event of a collision.
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head
restraint. To lower the head restraint, push the adjustment button, located at the base of the head restraint, and
push downward on the head restraint.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103
NOTE: The head restraints should only be removed by
qualified technicians, for service purposes only. If either
of the head restraints require removal, see your authorized dealership.
3
WARNING!
Do not place items over the top of the Reactive Head
Restraint, such as coats, seat covers or portable DVD
players. These items may interfere with the operation
of the Reactive Head Restraint in the event of a
collision and could result in serious injury or death.
Adjustment Button
Rear Head Restraints
The Reactive Head Restraints will automatically return to
their normal position following a rear impact. If the To raise the head restraint, pull upward on the head
Reactive Head Restraints do not return to their normal restraint. To lower the head restraint, push the adjustment button, located at the base of the head restraint, and
position, see your authorized dealership immediately.
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
push downward on the head restraint. Refer to “Occu- TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD
pant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting To open the hood, two latches must be released.
Your Vehicle” for information on tether routing.
1. Pull the bottom of the RED hood release lever, located
on the left kick panel, rearward.
Adjustment Button
Hood Release Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105
2. Rotate the safety catch under the front edge of the 3. Lift the hood prop rod that clips to the right side (left
hood, near the center, and raise the hood.
side when standing in front of the hood) of the engine
compartment. Place the hood prop rod in the hole of
hood hinge to secure the hood in the open position.
3
Hood Safety Latch Location
Hood Prop Rod
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
In hot climates, the prop rod may be hot. Pick up the prop LIGHTS
rod at the foam on the end of the prop rod.
Multifunction Lever
CAUTION!
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood to
close it. Lower the hood until it is open approximately 6 inches (15 cm), and then drop it. This should
secure both latches. Never drive your vehicle unless
the hood is fully closed, with both latches engaged.
WARNING!
Be sure the hood is fully latched before driving your
vehicle. If the hood is not fully latched, it could open
when the vehicle is in motion and block your vision.
Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
injury or death.
The multifunction lever, located on the left side of the
steering wheel, controls the operation of the headlights,
headlight beam selection, passing light and turn signals.
NOTE: The external lights can only be turned on with
the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
Headlights
Rotate the end of the multifunction lever upward to the first detent for headlight operation.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107
High Beams
With the low beams activated, push the multifunction lever towards the instrument panel to
turn on the high beams. Pull the multifunction lever
toward the steering wheel to turn off the high beams.
Flash-To-Pass
Headlight Operation
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by
partially pulling the multifunction lever toward the steering wheel. This will cause the high beam headlights to
turn on until the lever is released.
NOTE: When the headlights are turned on, the Daytime Parking Lights
Running Lights will be deactivated.
To turn on the parking lights, remove the key
or turn the ignition to OFF/LOCK position and
turn on the headlights.
3
108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Daytime Running Lights — If Equipped
To activate the Daytime Running Lights (DRL), rotate the
end of the multifunction lever to the O symbol.
NOTE: The low beams and side/taillights will not be on
with DRL.
If allowed by law in the country in which the vehicle was
purchased the DRL function can be turned on or off using
the display menus. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument
Panel” for further information.
Turn Signals
Turn Signal Operation
Push the multifunction lever upward to signal a right NOTE: The indicators will automatically turn off when
turn or downward to signal a left turn. The correspond- the turn has been completed and the steering wheel is
ing indicator in the instrument cluster will blink to returned to a straight position.
indicate the operation of the turn signal.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109
Lane Change Assist
Deactivation
Tap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond Pull the multifunction lever toward the steering wheel
the detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash and hold it for more than two seconds.
three times then automatically turn off.
Interior Lights
Follow Me Home/Headlight Delay
The interior light switches are located in the overhead
When this feature is selected the driver can choose to console. The interior lights can be set to three different
have the headlights remain on for a preset period of time. positions (Off/Left Position, Center Position, On/Right
Position).
Activation
Using the switch on the left overhead, push the switch to
Remove the key or turn the ignition to the OFF/LOCK
the right from its center position and the lights are always
position, and pull the multifunction lever toward the
on. Push the switch to the left from its center position and
steering wheel, within two minutes. Each time the lever
the lights are always off. Leave the switch in the center
is pulled, the activation of the lights will be extended by
position, and the lights are turned on and off when the
30 seconds. The activation of the lights can be extended to
doors are opened or closed. The switch on the right side
a maximum of 210 seconds.
of the overhead console controls the map or reading
function of the lights. Push the switch to the right to turn
3
110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
on the right light and push the switch to the left to turn • When the key is removed from the ignition (within
two minutes of the ignition being turned off), a 10
on the left light.
second timer is activated.
CAUTION!
Before getting out of the vehicle be sure that the
switch is in the center position or that the lights are
off to avoid draining the battery.
Interior Light Timing (Center Position)
• When the doors are unlocked with the Key Fob a 10
second timer is activated.
• When the doors are locked with the Key Fob the lights
will turn off.
Interior Light Timing (On/Right Position)
There are four different modes of operation that can be • When all doors are closed a 15 minute timer is
activated in this position:
activated.
• When one door is opened a three minute timer is NOTE: The timer is deactivated when the key is moved
activated.
into the ON/RUN position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111
Push the switch once to turn the front fog lights on. Push
The fog light switch is located on the center stack of the the switch a second time to turn the front fog lights off.
instrument panel, just below the radio.
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
Front Fog Lights — If Equipped
The windshield wiper/washer lever is located on the
right side of the steering column.
NOTE: The windshield wipers/washers will only operate with the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
Fog Light Switch
3
112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Front Windshield Wiper Operation
Windshield Wiper Off
There are five different modes of operation for the front This is the normal position of the wiper lever.
windshield wipers. The windshield wiper lever can be
Intermittent Wiper Operation
raised or lowered to access these modes:
Push the lever downward to the first detent. The wipers
will operate intermittently.
NOTE: The Intermittent function only has one detent
but wiper delay will vary with changes in vehicle speed.
As vehicle speed increases the delay time will decrease.
Low Speed
Push the lever downward to the second detent. The
wipers will operate at low speed.
High Speed
Windshield Wiper Operation
Push the lever downward to the third detent. The wipers
will operate at high speed.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113
Manual High Speed/Mist
Push the lever upward from the off position. The wipers
will operate at high speed to clear off road mist or spray
from a passing vehicle. This operation will continue until
the lever is released. When the lever is released, the
wipers will return to the off position and automatically
shut off.
Front Windshield Washer Operation
Pull the windshield wiper/washer lever toward the
steering wheel to activate the washers. The wipers will
activate automatically for three cycles after the lever is
released.
CAUTION!
• Turn the windshield wipers off when driving
through an automatic car wash. Damage to the
windshield wipers may result if the wiper control
is left in any position other than off.
• In cold weather, always turn off the wiper switch
and allow the wipers to return to the “Park” position before turning off the engine. If the wiper
switch is left on and the wipers freeze to the
windshield, damage to the wiper motor may occur
when the vehicle is restarted.
• Always remove any buildup of snow that prevents
the windshield wiper blades from returning to the
off position. If the windshield wiper control is
turned off and the blades cannot return to the off
position, damage to the wiper motor may occur.
3
114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Rear Windshield Wiper
Rotate the end of the windshield wiper/washer lever
upward to the first detent past the intermittent settings
for intermittent wipe operation. With the front windshield wiper active, rotate the end of the windshield
wiper/washer lever upward. The rear wiper will operate
in the same mode as the front windshield wipers, but at
half the frequency. When the transmission is shifted into
REVERSE, the rear wiper will automatically operate at
Low Speed and return to normal operation when the
transmission is shifted out of REVERSE.
Rear Wiper Operation
NOTE: The windshield wipers/washers will only operate with the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115
Rear Windshield Washer Operation
Push the windshield wiper/washer lever toward the
instrument panel to activate the rear washer. Push and
hold the lever for more than a half second and the wipers
will activate automatically for three cycles after the lever
is released.
3
TILT STEERING COLUMN — IF EQUIPPED
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
upward or downward. The tilt control lever is located on
the left-side of the steering column, below the turn signal
controls.
Tilt Control Lever
Push down on the lever to unlock the column. With one
hand firmly on the steering wheel, move the steering
column up or down as desired. Push the lever up to lock
the column firmly in place.
116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
The Electronic Speed Control buttons are located on the
right side of the steering wheel.
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious injury or
death.
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over
accelerator operations at speeds greater than 25 mph
(40 km/h).
Electronic Speed Control Buttons
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117
NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the ElecWARNING! (Continued)
tronic Speed Control system has been designed to shut
down if multiple Speed Control functions are operated at set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control You could lose control and have an accident. Always
system can be reactivated by pushing the Electronic leave the system OFF when you are not using it.
Speed Control ON/OFF button and resetting the desired
vehicle set speed.
To Set A Desired Speed
To Activate
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle
Push the ON/OFF button. The Cruise Indicator Light in has reached the desired speed, push the SET (-) button
the instrument cluster will illuminate. To turn the system and release. Release the accelerator and the vehicle will
off, push the ON/OFF button a second time. The Cruise operate at the selected speed.
Indicator Light will turn off. The system should be NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady speed
turned off when not in use.
and on level ground before pushing the SET (-) button.
To Deactivate
WARNING!
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
(Continued)
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the CANC button,
or normal brake pressure while slowing the vehicle will
deactivate Electronic Speed Control without erasing the
3
118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
set speed memory. Pushing the ON/OFF button or U.S. Speed (mph)
turning the ignition switch OFF erases the set speed in
• Pushing the RES (+) button once will result in a 1 mph
memory.
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
button results in an increase of 1 mph.
To Resume Speed
To resume a previously set speed, push the RES (+) • If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
button and release. Resume can be used at any speed
continue to increase until the button is released, then
above 25 mph (40 km/h).
the new set speed will be established.
To Vary The Speed Setting
Metric Speed (km/h)
• Pushing the RES (+) button once will result in a
1 km/h increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can inthe button results in an increase of 1 km/h.
crease speed by pushing the RES (+) button.
To Increase Speed
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the • If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
continue to increase until the button is released, then
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Underthe new set speed will be established.
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
The speed increment shown is dependent on the selected
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119
To Decrease Speed
Metric Speed (km/h)
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can de- • Pushing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 km/h
crease speed by pushing the SET (-) button.
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
button results in a decrease of 1 km/h.
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Under- • If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
continue to decrease until the button is released, then
The speed decrement shown is dependant on the selected
the new set speed will be established.
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
To Accelerate For Passing
U.S. Speed (mph)
Push the accelerator as you would normally. When the
• Pushing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 mph pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
Using Electronic Speed Control On Hills
button results in a decrease of 1 mph.
The transmission may downshift on hills to maintain the
• If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
vehicle set speed.
continue to decrease until the button is released, then
NOTE: The Electronic Speed Control system maintains
the new set speed will be established.
speed up and down hills. A slight speed change on
moderate hills is normal.
3
120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
On steep hills, a greater speed loss or gain may occur so The Rear Park Assist is automatically activated when the
it may be preferable to drive without Electronic Speed transmission is placed into REVERSE.
Control.
Rear Park Assist Sensors
WARNING!
Electronic Speed Control can be dangerous where the
system cannot maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle could go too fast for the conditions, and you
could lose control and have an accident. Do not use
Electronic Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads
that are winding, icy, snow-covered or slippery.
REAR PARK ASSIST — IF EQUIPPED
The four Rear Park Assist sensors, located in the rear
fascia/bumper, monitor the area behind the vehicle that
is within the sensors’ field of view. The sensors can detect
obstacles, in the horizontal direction, from approximately
12 in (30 cm) up to 55 in (140 cm) from the center of the
rear fascia/bumper and up to 24 in (60 cm) from the
corners of the rear fascia/bumper, depending on the
location, type and orientation of the obstacle.
If several obstacles are detected, the Rear Park Assist
The Rear Park Assist system provides visual and audible system indicates the nearest obstacle.
indications of the distance between the rear fascia/ The minimum height of a detectable obstacle correbumper and a detected obstacle when backing up, e.g. sponds to the maximum height of an obstacle that would
during a parking maneuver. Refer to the “Park Assist clear the underside of the car during the parking maneuSystem Usage Precautions” for the limitations of this ver.
system and recommendations.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121
Rear Park Assist Warning Display
If an obstacle is detected in the left and/or right rear region,
the display will show solid arcs in the left and/or right rear
region and will produce an audible alert. As the vehicle
moves closer to the obstacle, the display will show fewer
arcs and the audible alert becomes more frequent.
The Rear Park Assist Warning screen is located within the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). It provides
audible and visual warnings to indicate the distance
between the rear fascia/bumper and the detected obstacle. Refer to ⬙Electronic Vehicle Information Center Rear Park Assist Audible Alerts
(EVIC)⬙ in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel⬙ for
If an obstacle is behind the vehicle when the transmission
further information.
is placed into REVERSE, an audible alert is activated.
Rear Park Assist Display
The tones emitted by the loudspeaker inform the driver
When the vehicle is in REVERSE, the warning display that the vehicle is approaching an obstacle. The pauses
will turn ON indicating the system status.
between the tones are directly proportional to the disThe system will indicate a detected obstacle by showing tance from the obstacle. Pulses emitted in quick succesarcs in one or more regions based on the obstacle’s sion indicate the presence of a very close obstacle. A
continuous tone indicates that the obstacle is less than 12
distance and location relative to the vehicle.
in (30 cm) away.
If an obstacle is detected in the center rear region, the
display will show solid arcs in the center rear region and
will produce an audible alert. As the vehicle moves closer
to the obstacle, the display will show fewer arcs and the
audible alert becomes more frequent.
3
122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Audible And Visual Signals Supplied By The Rear Park Assist System
SIGNAL
Obstacle Distance
MEANING
An obstacle is present within the
sensors’ field of view
Failure
Sensor or System failures
INDICATION
Audible signal (dashboard loudspeaker)
• Sound pulses emitted at a rate that increases
as the distance decreases.
• Emits continuous tone at 12 in (30 cm).
• Adjustable volume level. (Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for
further information).
Visual signal (EVIC)
• Arcs are shown based on the obstacle’s distance and location relative to the vehicle. (Refer to “Rear Park Assist Display” for further
information).
Visual Signal (instrument panel)
• Icon appears on display.
• Message is displayed on the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC) (where provided).
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123
While audible signals are emitted, the audio system is not Refer to ⬙Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)⬙ in
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further
muted.
information.
The audible signal is turned off immediately if the
distance increases. The tone cycle remains constant if the The sensors and wiring are tested continuously when the
distance measured by the inner sensors is constant. If this ignition is in the ON/RUN position. Failures are indicondition occurs for the external sensors, the signal is cated immediately if they occur when the system is ON.
turned off after 3 seconds (stopping warnings during Even if the system is able to identify that a specific sensor
maneuvers parallel to walls).
is in failure condition, the EVIC shall indicate that the
Rear Park Assist system is unavailable, without reference
to the sensor in failure condition. If even a single sensor
A malfunction of the Rear Park Assist sensors or system
fails, the entire system must be disabled. The system is
is indicated, during REVERSE gear engagement, by the
turned off automatically.
instrument panel warning icon and message displayed
on the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Cleaning The Rear Park Assist System
display.
Clean the Rear Park Assist sensors with water, car wash
Failure Indications
The warning icon is illuminated and a message soap and a soft cloth. Do not use rough or hard cloths. In
is displayed on the EVIC display (if equipped). washing stations, clean sensors quickly keeping the vapor jet/high pressure washing nozzles at least 4 in (10
3
124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
cm) from the sensors. Do not scratch or poke the sensors.
Otherwise, you could damage the sensors.
Park Assist System Usage Precautions
not detect an obstacle behind the fascia/bumper, or it
could provide a false indication that an obstacle is
behind the fascia/bumper.
• Objects such as bicycle carriers, etc., must not be
placed within 12 in (30 cm) from the rear fascia/
• Ensure that the outer surface and the underside of the
bumper while driving the vehicle. Failure to do so can
rear bumper is clean and clear of snow, ice, mud, dirt
result in the system misinterpreting a close object as a
or other obstruction to keep the Rear Park Assist
sensor problem, causing a failure indication to be
system operating properly.
displayed in the instrument cluster.
NOTE:
• Jackhammers, large trucks, and other vibrations could
affect the performance of Rear Park Assist.
CAUTION!
• Clean the Rear Park Assist sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them. The sensors must
not be covered with ice, snow, slush, mud, dirt or
debris. Failure to do so can result in the system not
working properly. The Rear Park Assist system might
• Rear Park Assist is only a parking aid and it is
unable to recognize every obstacle, including small
obstacles. Parking curbs might be temporarily detected or not detected at all. Obstacles located
above or below the sensors will not be detected
when they are in close proximity.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125
CAUTION! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• The vehicle must be driven slowly when using
Rear Park Assist in order to be able to stop in time
when an obstacle is detected. It is recommended
that the driver looks over his/her shoulder when
using Rear Park Assist.
• Before using the Rear Park Assist System, it is
strongly recommended that the ball mount and
hitch ball assembly is disconnected from the vehicle when the vehicle is not used for towing.
Failure to do so can result in injury or damage to
vehicles or obstacles because the hitch ball will be
much closer to the obstacle than the rear fascia
when the warning display turns on the single
flashing arc and sounds the continuous tone. Also,
the sensors could detect the ball mount and hitch
ball assembly, depending on its size and shape,
giving a false indication that an obstacle is behind
the vehicle.
WARNING!
• Drivers must be careful when backing up even when
using the Rear Park Assist system. Always check
carefully behind your vehicle, look behind you, and
be sure to check for pedestrians, animals, other
vehicles, obstructions, and blind spots before backing up. You are responsible for safety and must
continue to pay attention to your surroundings. Failure to do so can result in serious injury or death.
(Continued)
3
126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED
The power sunroof roof switch is located in the overhead
console.
Power Sunroof Switch
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Never leave the Key
Fob in or near the vehicle, or in a location accessible to children. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by the
power sunroof while operating the power sunroof
switch. Such entrapment may result in serious
injury or death.
• In a collision, there is a greater risk of being thrown
from a vehicle with an open sunroof. You could
also be seriously injured or killed. Always fasten
your seat belt properly and make sure all passengers are properly secured.
• Do not allow small children to operate the sunroof.
Never allow your fingers, other body parts, or any
object to project through the sunroof opening.
Injury may result.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127
To Open
Pinch Protect Feature
Push and hold the power sunroof switch rearward for
approximately one second and the sunroof will stop at
the vented position. Push the switch a second time and
hold for approximately one second and release, the
sunroof will open fully, then stop automatically. This is
called “Express Open”. During Express Open operation,
any movement of the sunroof switch will stop the
sunroof.
This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of
the sunroof during Express Close operation. If an obstruction in the path of the sunroof is detected, the
sunroof will automatically retract. Remove the obstruction if this occurs. Next, push the switch forward and
release to Express Close.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
With the sunroof in the full open position, pull the power ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
sunroof button and hold it for approximately one second, windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
the sunroof will return to the vented position. Pull the open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurswitch a second time and hold for approximately one rence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
second to completely close the sunroof.
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to
minimize the buffeting or open any window.
To Close
3
128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Emergency Operation
In case of electrical failure the sunroof can be operated
with the hex wrench that is located in the glove box.
There is a plug located in the rear of the sunroof opening
at the center of the vehicle. Removing the plug reveals a
hex opening in the motor assembly of the sunroof. Insert
the hex wrench and turn, moving the sunroof to the
desired location.
Sun Shade — If Equipped
For vehicles equipped with either a power sunroof or a
fixed glass roof, there is a sun shade that can be open or
Manual Sun Shade
closed. To open the sun shade push the tab and move the
ELECTRICAL
POWER
OUTLETS
shade to a full open position.
There is a standard 12 Volt (13 Amp) power outlet,
located in the floor console, for added convenience. This
power outlet can power mobile phones, electronics and
other low power devices.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129
CAUTION!
Power Outlet
Power is available when the ignition switch is in the
ON/RUN or START position. Insert the cigar lighter or
accessory plug into the outlet for use. To preserve the
heating element, do not hold the lighter in the heating
position.
• Do not exceed the maximum power of 160 Watts (13
Amps) at 12 Volts. If the 160 Watts (13 Amps) power
rating is exceeded, the fuse protecting the system
will need to be replaced.
• Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs
only. Do not insert any other object in the power
outlets as this will damage the outlet and blow the
fuse. Improper use of the power outlet can cause
damage not covered by your New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
3
130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this type of outlet
should be inserted into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lid when not in use and while driving the
vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an electric
shock and failure.
Power Outlet Fuse Location Underhood
F15 Fuse 15 A Blue Cigar Lighter Front Console
CAUTION!
• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw
power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not in
use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers,
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.) will degrade the battery even more quickly. Only use these intermittently and with great caution.
• After the use of high power draw accessories, or
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the
generator to recharge the vehicle’s battery.
CIGAR LIGHTER — IF EQUIPPED
This is located on the center console, in front of the cup
holders. To activate the cigar lighter, push and release the
knob. After a few seconds the knob automatically returns
to its initial position, and the cigar lighter is ready for use.
WARNING!
When the cigar lighter is in use it becomes very hot.
To avoid serious injury, handle the cigar lighter with
care. Always check that the cigar lighter has turned
off.
3
132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
For rear passengers, there are cupholders located on the
For the driver and front passenger, cupholders are lo- floor between the front driver and passenger seats.
cated on the floor console between the front seats.
CUPHOLDERS
Rear Cupholders
Front Cupholders
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133
STORAGE
Glove Compartment
The glove compartment is located on the right side of the
instrument panel. Pull outward on the glove compartment latch to open the glove compartment. Push the
glove compartment door upward to close it.
3
Glove Compartment Latch
CARGO AREA FEATURES
The rear seatbacks have a fold down feature to allow
increased cargo capacity.
134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Push down the release button, located at the outboard
top of the seatback and move the seatback to its foldeddown position to provide a flat load floor cargo area.
When returning the seatback to its upright position, push
rearward until the seatback is properly latched.
Folded Rear Seats
Rear Seat Release Buttons
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135
REAR WINDOW FEATURES
Rear Window Defroster
The rear window defroster button is located in the
center of the instrument panel, below the radio.
Push this button to turn on the rear window defroster. An
indicator in the instrument cluster will illuminate when
the rear window defroster is on. The rear window
defroster automatically turns off after approximately 20
minutes. To manually shut the defroster off, push the
button a second time.
NOTE: To prevent excessive battery drain, use the rear
window defroster only when the engine is operating.
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
3
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
䡵 INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES . . . . . . . . . .139
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER — ECO . . . . . . . . . . .141
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER — POP, LOUNGE,
500C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
▫ Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
▫ Change Engine Oil Indicator System . . . . . . . .160
▫ Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
▫ Trip Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS . . . . .143
▫ Trip Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
䡵 ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ Values Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
▫ EVIC Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
▫ Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable
Features). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ EVIC Control Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 䡵 SALES CODE (RAB) RADIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
4
138 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
▫ Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177 䡵 STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS . . . . . .204
▫ Suggestions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
▫ Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
▫ Technical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
▫ CD Player Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
▫ Quick Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
▫ Operating Instructions — Hands-Free Phone
(If Equipped). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
▫ General Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
▫ Functions And Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
▫ Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
▫ SiriusXM Satellite Radio — If Equipped. . . . . .194
▫ CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
▫ CD MP3 Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
▫ Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
䡵 iPod®/USB/MEDIA PLAYER CONTROL — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
䡵 CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . .205
䡵 RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES . .206
䡵 CLIMATE CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
▫ Manual Heating And Air Conditioning . . . . . .207
▫ Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . .209
▫ Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 139
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
—
—
—
—
—
—
Side Vent
Multifunction Lever – Light Control
Instrument Cluster And Warning Lights
Windshield Wiper, Washer, Trip Computer
Central Air Vents
Storage Compartment/Radio
7 — Passenger Air Bag
8 — Glove Compartment
9 — Rear Defrost Button
10 — Hazard Button
11 — Climate Controls
12 — Power Windows Control
13
14
15
16
—
—
—
—
Storage Compartment
Shift Lever
Sport Button
Horn/Driver Airbag
140 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 141
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER — ECO
4
142 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER — POP, LOUNGE, 500C
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 143
on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
1. Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light — If Equipped overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
should be checked monthly when cold and
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended
tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to
by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle
maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS
has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the
low tire pressure telltale.
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not
tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is
equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. approximately one minute and then remain continuously
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illumi- illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsenates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as quent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS
4
144 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety
of reasons, including the installation of replacement or
alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the
TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more
tires or wheels on your vehicle, to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
to continue to function properly.
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
sensor to become inoperable. After using an aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended that you take
your vehicle to an authorized dealership to have your
sensor function checked.
CAUTION!
2. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator
Light — If Equipped
The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
(Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
This light indicates the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is off.
3. Turn Signal Indicators
The arrow will flash with the exterior turn
signal when the turn signal lever is operated.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 145
(kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see
• A continuous chime will sound if the vehicle is your authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the
driven more than 1 mile (1.6 km) with either turn problem diagnosed and corrected.
signal on.
NOTE:
NOTE:
• Check for an inoperative outside light bulb if either
indicator remains on and does not flash, or flashes at
a rapid rate.
4. Electronic Stability Control
Malfunction Indicator Light
(ESC)
Activation/
The “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
Light” in the instrument cluster will come on
when the ignition switch is turned to the
ON/RUN position. It should go out with the
engine running. If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” comes on continuously with the engine
running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC
system. If this light remains on after several ignition
cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles
• The “ESC Off Indicator Light” and the “ESC
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light” come on
momentarily each time the ignition switch is turned
to ON/RUN.
• Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the
ESC system will be ON, even if it was turned off
previously.
• The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking
sounds when it is active. This is normal; the sounds
will stop when ESC becomes inactive following the
maneuver that caused the ESC activation.
4
146 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
beam. Pull the lever toward you to switch the headlights
back to low beam. If the driver’s door is open, and the
This light will turn on for four to eight seconds
headlights or park lights are left on, the high beam
as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first
indicator light will remain illuminated and a chime will
turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on
sound.
during starting, stays on, or turns on while
driving, have the system inspected at an authorized 8. Seat Belt Reminder Light
dealer as soon as possible. Refer to “Occupant Restraints”
When the ignition switch is first turned to
in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
ON/RUN, this light will turn on for four to
further information.
eight seconds as a bulb check. During the bulb
5. Air Bag Warning Light
check, if the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled, a
chime will sound. After the bulb check or when driving,
This indicator will illuminate when the park
if the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled, the seat belt
lights or headlights are turned on.
reminder light will flash or remain on continuously. Refer
to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before
Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
7. High Beam Indicator
6. Park/Headlight ON Indicator — If Equipped
This light shows that the high beam headlights
are on. Push the multifunction control lever
away from you to switch the headlights to high
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 147
Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not
need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as
The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) is part
soon as possible.
of an onboard diagnostic (OBDII) system
which monitors the emissions and engine conCAUTION!
trol system. If the vehicle is ready for emissions
testing, the light will come on when the ignition is first Prolonged driving with the Malfunction Indicator
turned on and remain on, as a bulb check, until the Light (MIL) on could cause damage to the engine
engine is started. If the vehicle is not ready for emissions
control system. It also could affect fuel economy and
testing the light will come on when the ignition is first driveability. If the MIL is flashing, severe catalytic
turned on and remain on for 15 seconds, then blink for 5 converter damage and power loss will soon occur.
seconds, and remain on until the vehicle is started. If the Immediate service is required.
bulb does not come on during starting, have the condition investigated promptly.
9. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
If this light comes on and remains on while driving, it
suggests a potential engine control problem and the need
for system service.
WARNING!
A malfunctioning catalytic converter, as referenced
above, can reach higher temperatures than in normal
operating conditions. This can cause a fire if you
(Continued)
4
148 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
WARNING! (Continued)
drive slowly or park over flammable substances such
as dry plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could result
in death or serious injury to the driver, occupants or
others.
10. Front Fog Light Indicator — If Equipped
This indicator will illuminate when the front
fog lights are on.
11. Electric Power Steering Malfunction Warning Light
This telltale is on when the Electric Power
Steering is not operating and needs service.
12. Rear Fog Light Indicator — If Equipped
This indicator will illuminate when the rear fog
lights are on.
13. Rear Defrost Indicator
This indicator will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window defroster
automatically turns off after 20 minutes.
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 149
14. Brake Warning Light
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
system. A leak in either half of the dual brake system is
indicated by the Brake Warning Light, which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder has
dropped below a specified level.
This light monitors various brake functions,
including brake fluid level and parking brake
application. If the brake light turns on it may
indicate that the parking brake is applied, that
the brake fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
the Anti-lock Brake System reservoir.
If the light remains on when the parking brake has been
disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full mark on the
master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brake
hydraulic system malfunction or that a problem with the
Brake Booster has been detected by the Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS) / Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system.
In this case, the light will remain on until the condition
has been corrected. If the problem is related to the brake
booster, the ABS pump will run when applying the brake
and a brake pedal pulsation may be felt during each stop.
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp
cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level conditions. The vehicle should have service performed, and
the brake fluid level checked.
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necessary.
4
150 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
WARNING!
Driving a vehicle with the red brake light on is
dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed.
It will take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have
a collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
Vehicles equipped with the ABS, are also equipped with
Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD). In the event of
an EBD failure, the Brake Warning Light will turn on
along with the ABS Light. Immediate repair to the ABS
system is required.
Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked by
turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to the
ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light should then turn off
unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is
detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light
inspected by an authorized dealer.
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
15. Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light
This light monitors the Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS). The light will turn on when the ignition
switch is turned to the ON/RUN position and
may stay on for as long as four seconds.
If the ABS light remains on or turns on while driving, it
indicates that the anti-lock portion of the brake system is
not functioning and that service is required. However,
the conventional brake system will continue to operate
normally if the BRAKE warning light is not on.
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced
as soon as possible to restore the benefits of anti-lock
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 151
brakes. If the ABS light does not turn on when the
ignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position, have
the light inspected by an authorized dealer.
16. Gas Pedal Percentage Gauge/Turbo Gauge/ECO Index Gauge
Depending on what options and trim level, your vehicle
is equipped with there are three gauges available.
• Gas Pedal Percentage Gauge: This gauge shows
what percent the gas pedal is currently depressed at.
• Turbo Gauge: This gauge shows the current turbo
usage.
• ECO Index Gauge: The ECO Index gauge allows the
driver to monitor their driving style in order to
increase fuel economy. The efficiency of the driving
style is displayed on a gauge located on the right
side of the instrument cluster and ranges from a
minimum value of 0 up to a maximum value of 5 (0
= low, 5 = high). A higher “ECO” index indicates a
more fuel efficient drive style and will increase your
fuel economy. A lower “ECO” index indicates frequent accelerations/decelerations and will decrease
your fuel economy. The index is recalculated approximately every second and takes into account a
combination of the instant fuel economy and your
driving style during the current trip.
NOTE: Different trips may have different values even if
the same driving style is maintained. Some factors that
may impact the calculated index value are:
• Traffic conditions
• Trip duration
• Temperature (engine and ambient)
17. Fuel Gauge
Shows level of fuel in tank when ignition switch is in the
ON/RUN position.
4
152 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
18. Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
The EVIC features a driver-interactive display that is
located in the instrument cluster. For further information,
refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel.”
19. Temperature Gauge
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant temperature. Any reading within the normal range indicates that
the engine cooling system is operating satisfactorily.
The gauge pointer will likely indicate a higher temperature when driving in hot weather, up mountain grades,
or when towing a trailer. It should not be allowed to
exceed the upper limits of the normal operating range.
CAUTION!
Driving with a hot engine cooling system could
damage your vehicle. If the temperature gauge reads
“H” pull over and stop the vehicle. Idle the vehicle
with the air conditioner turned off until the pointer
drops back into the normal range. If the pointer
remains on the “H” and you hear continuous chimes,
turn the engine off immediately and call an authorized dealer for service.
WARNING!
A hot engine cooling system is dangerous. You or
others could be badly burned by steam or boiling
coolant. You may want to call an authorized dealer
for service if your vehicle overheats. If you decide to
look under the hood yourself, see “Maintaining Your
(Continued)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 153
then the odometer must be set at zero, and a sticker must
be placed in the door jamb stating what the mileage was
Vehicle.” Follow the warnings under the “Cooling before the repair or service. It is a good idea for you to
System Pressure Cap” paragraph.
make a record of the odometer reading before the repair/
service, so that you can be sure that it is properly reset, or
20. Tachometer
that the door jamb sticker is accurate if the odometer
The tachometer indicates engine speed in Revolutions must be reset at zero.
Per Minute (RPM x 1000).
NOTE: If the vehicle is equipped with the Electronic
21. Speedometer / Trip Odometer / Electronic Vehicle Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) in the instrument
Information Center (EVIC) Display Area
cluster, all warnings including “door” and “gate” and
This display indicates the total distance the vehicle has “Change Engine Oil” will only be displayed in the EVIC
display. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center
been driven.
(EVIC) in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel.”
U.S. Federal regulations require that upon transfer of
vehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the 22. Low Fuel Light
correct mileage that the vehicle has been driven. If your
When the fuel level reaches approximately 1.0
odometer needs to be repaired or serviced, the repair
gallon (3.8L), this light will turn on, and remain
technician should leave the odometer reading the same on until fuel is added.
as it was before the repair or service. If s/he cannot do so,
WARNING! (Continued)
4
154 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
23. Generic Warning Light
while driving, turn off some of the vehicle’s non-essential
electrical devices or increase engine speed (if at idle). If
the charging system light remains on, it means that the
vehicle is experiencing a problem with the charging
system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY. See an authorized dealer.
The Generic Warning Light will illuminate if
any of the following conditions occur: Oil
Change Request, Engine Oil Pressure Sensor
Failure, External Light Failure, Fuel Cut-Off
Intervention, Fuel Cut-Off Not Available, Parking Sensor
If jump starting is required, refer to “Jump Starting
Failure.
Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies.”
24. Cruise On Indicator — If Equipped
26. Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) Light
This light will turn on when the electronic
This light informs you of a problem with the
speed control is ON. For further information,
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. If a
refer to “Electronic Speed Control” in “Underproblem is detected, the light will come on
standing Your Instrument Panel.”
while the engine is running. Cycle the ignition
25. Charging System Light
key when the vehicle has completely stopped and the
This light shows the status of the electrical charg- shift lever is placed in the NEUTRAL position. The light
ing system. The light should come on when the should turn off. If the light remains lit with the engine
ignition switch is first turned to ON/RUN and remain on running, your vehicle will usually be drivable. However,
briefly as a bulb check. If the light stays on or comes on see an authorized dealer for service as soon as possible. If
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 155
the light is flashing when the engine is running, immediate service is required and you may experience reduced
performance, an elevated/rough idle or engine stall and
your vehicle may require towing. The light will come on
when the ignition is first turned to ON/RUN and remain
on briefly as a bulb check. If the light does not come on
during starting, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
28. Engine Temperature Warning Light
This light warns of an overheated engine condition. The engine coolant temperature indicator
will illuminate and a single chime will sound after
reaching a set threshold.
If the light turns on while driving, safely pull over and
stop the vehicle. If the A/C system is on, turn it off. Also,
shift the transmission into NEUTRAL and idle the ve27. Oil Pressure Warning Light
hicle. If the temperature reading does not return to
This light indicates low engine oil pressure. The normal, turn the engine off immediately and call for
light should turn on momentarily when the engine is service. Refer to “If Your Engine Overheats” in “What To
started. If the light turns on while driving, stop the Do In Emergencies” for further information.
vehicle and shut off the engine as soon as possible. A
chime will sound for four minutes when this light turns ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC)
on.
Do not operate the vehicle until the cause is corrected. The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) feaThis light does not indicate how much oil is in the engine. tures a driver-interactive display that is located in the
instrument cluster.
The engine oil level must be checked under the hood.
4
156 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The EVIC consists of the following:
• System Status
• Vehicle Information Warning Message Displays
• Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable Features)
• Outside Temperature Display
• Trip Computer Functions
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Display
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Display
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 157
• Door Ajar
• Speed Limiter — If Equipped
EVIC Displays
2. Amber Telltales
• Ice Risk
• Fuel Cut Off
• Fuel Cut Off Failed
• Hill Holder Failed
• Oil Change Request
• Check Lights
• Vehicle Lock
3. Electronic Speed Control Active
Instrument Cluster
1. Red Telltales (Left Bank)
• Hood Ajar
• Low Oil Pressure
• Electronic Throttle Control
4. Amber Telltales
• Generic Warning Light
• Glow Plug Light
• Park Sensor Failed
• Stop Lamp Failed
4
158 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
5. Red Telltales (Right Bank)
• Trunk Ajar
• Transmission Failure
• Battery Charge Indicator
6. Exceeded Speed Limiter
7. Shift Up or Down Indicators
8. Gear Indicator
button to scroll downPush and release the DOWN
ward through the displayed menu and the related
options or to decrease the value displayed.
NOTE: UP
and DOWN
buttons activate different functions according to the following situations:
• To scroll the menu options upwards or downwards.
• To increase or decrease values during settings.
NOTE: When opening one of the front doors, the EVIC
display will turn on the clock and the miles or kilometers
Push and release the MENU button briefly to access the covered (for versions/markets, where provided) for a
EVIC. Push and hold the MENU button (approximately few seconds.
one second) to return to the main screen.
EVIC Control Buttons
button to scroll upward
Push and release the UP
through the displayed menu and the related options
or to increase the displayed value.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 159
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Setup Menu
• Autoclose
• Units
The menu comprises a series of functions arranged in a
• Language
cycle. Push and release the UP and DOWN buttons
to access the different options and settings (setup).
• Buzzer Volume
The setup menu can be activated by pushing the MENU • Button Volume
button. A single push on the UP or DOWN buttons
will scroll through the setup menu options. The menu • Daylights (D.R.L.)
includes the following functions:
• Hill Start
• Speed Beep
• Tire Pressure
• Trip B Data
• Unlock Driver Door First
• Set Time
• Unlock All Doors
• Set Date
• Exit Menu
• See Radio
• Speed Display
4
160 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Selecting An Option Of The Main Menu Without 3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to select
Submenu
the displayed submenu option and to open the relevant setup menu.
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button to select
or DOWN
button (by
the main menu option to set.
4. Push and release the UP
single pushes) to select the new setting for this
or DOWN
button (by
2. Push and release the UP
submenu option.
single pushes) to select the new setting.
5. Briefly push and release the MENU button to store the
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to store the
new setting and go back to the previously selected
new setting and go back to the main menu option
submenu option.
previously selected.
Selecting An Option Of The Main Menu With Sub- 6. Push and hold the MENU button to return to the main
menu (short hold) or the main screen (longer hold).
menu
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button to display Change Engine Oil Indicator System
the first submenu option.
Change Engine Oil
or DOWN
button (by Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil change
2. Push and release the UP
single pushes) to scroll through all the submenu indicator system. The “Change Engine Oil” message will
options.
flash in the EVIC display for approximately 10 seconds
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 161
after a single chime has sounded to indicate the next
scheduled oil change interval. The engine oil change
indicator system is duty cycle based, which means the
engine oil change interval may fluctuate, dependent
upon your personal driving style.
Unless reset, this message will continue to display each
time you turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN
position. To turn off the message temporarily, push and
release the MENU button. To reset the oil change indicator system (after performing the scheduled maintenance),
refer to the following procedure.
NOTE: If the indicator message illuminates when you
start the vehicle, the oil change indicator system did not
reset. If necessary, repeat this procedure.
Trip Computer
The Trip Computer is located in the instrument cluster. It
features a driver-interactive display (displays information such as trip information, range, fuel consumption,
average speed, and travel time).
Trip Button
The TRIP button, located on the right steering column
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. (do not stalk, can be used to display and to reset the previously
described values.
start the engine.)
2. Fully push the accelerator pedal slowly, three times • A short button push displays the different values.
within 10 seconds.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF/LOCK position.
• A long button push resets the system and then starts a
new trip.
4
162 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
New Trip
Start Of Trip Procedure
To reset:
With the ignition on, push and hold the TRIP button for
over one second to reset.
• Push and hold the TRIP button to reset the system
Exit Trip
manually.
• When the “Trip distance” reaches 9999.9 miles or
kilometers or when the “Travel time” reaches 999.59
(999 hours and 59 minutes), the system is reset automatically.
To exit the Trip function, wait until all the values have
been displayed or hold the MENU button for longer than
one second.
Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back to
• Disconnecting/Reconnecting the battery resets the the menu screen or push and hold the MENU (approximately one second) to go back to the main screen without
system.
storing settings.
NOTE: If the reset operation occurs in the presence of
the screens concerning Trip A or Trip B, only the information associated with Trip A or Trip B functions will be
reset.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 163
Trip Functions
• Average speed B
Both trip functions are resettable (reset — start of new • Travel time B (driving time)
trip).
NOTE: “Trip B” functions may be excluded (see “Trip
“Trip A” can be used to display the figures relating to:
B Data”). “Range” and “Instantaneous consumption”
cannot be reset.
• Range
• Trip distance A
Values Displayed
• Average consumption
Range
• Instantaneous consumption
This indicates the distance which may be traveled with
the fuel remaining in the tank, assuming that driving
conditions will not change. The message “----” will
appear on the display in the following cases:
• Average speed A
• Travel time A (driving time)
“Trip B” can be used to display the figures relating to:
• Trip distance B
• Average consumption
• Distance less than 30 miles (or 50 km).
• The vehicle is parked for a long time with the engine
running.
4
164 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The range depends on several factors: driving Travel Time
style, type of route (freeway, residential, mountain roads, This value shows the time elapsed since the last reset.
etc.), conditions of use of the car (load, tire pressure, etc.).
Personal Settings (Customer-Programmable
Trip planning must take into account the above notes.
Features)
Distance Traveled
Dimmer
This value shows the distance covered since the last reset.
The EVIC display is provided with a light sensor capable
Average Economy
of detecting environmental light conditions and adjustThis value shows the approximate average consumption ing the brightness of the instruments accordingly.
since the last reset.
NOTE: The brightness of the instrument panel may
Instant Economy
change while travelling following an event that causes
This indicates the fuel consumption. The value is con- switching from “day” to “night” conditions (or vice
stantly updated. The message “----” will appear on the versa) in the passenger compartment (e.g. in a tunnel, on
avenues in shadows, under bridges, etc.).
display if the car is parked with the engine running.
Average Speed
To adjust the brightness, proceed as follows:
or DOWN
This value shows the vehicle’s average speed as a func- 1. Push and release the UP
set
the
required
brightness
level.
tion of the overall time elapsed since the last reset.
button to
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 165
2. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back 3. When the function is activated (On), briefly push and
to the menu screen or push and hold the MENU
release the MENU button to display the presently set
or DOWN
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
activation speed. Pushing the UP
buttons selects the speed limit. Push and release
screen without storing settings.
the MENU button to confirm selection.
Speed Beep (Speed Limit)
With this function, it is possible to set the car speed limit NOTE: The setting can be increased or decreased by
(mph or km/h) to immediately alert the driver when the 5 mph or km/h each time the UP/DOWN button is
pushed for speed settings above 20 mph (32 km/h). To
set limit is exceeded.
increase or decrease the set speed rapidly, push and hold
To set the speed limit, proceed as follows:
the UP/DOWN button. Save the setting by briefly push1. Briefly push and release the MENU button to enter the ing the button when you approach the required setting.
• Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
or DOWN
button to
2. Push and release the UP
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
select Speed Beep. Push and release the MENU
main screen without storing the settings.
or DOWN
button, push and release the UP
buttons to select Speed Limit activation (On) or
deactivation (Off).
Main MENU.
4
166 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button to
select Trip B data. Push and release the UP
or
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. “On” will
buttons to turn ON or OFF
DOWN
flash on the display.
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
button. “Off” will
2. Push and release the DOWN
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
flash on the display.
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
main screen without storing the settings.
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
Set Time (Clock)
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
This function may be used to set the clock through two
main screen without storing the settings.
submenu items: “Time” and “Mode.”
Trip B Data (Trip B On)
Proceed as follows:
Through this option, it is possible to activate (On) or
deactivate (Off) the Trip B (partial trip) display.
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
or DOWN
buttons to highlight
release the UP
For further information, see “Trip Computer.”
Set Time — Push and release the MENU button.
For activation / deactivation, proceed as follows:
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button to
navigate the two sub-menu items.
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button.
To cancel the setting, proceed as follows:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 167
3. Select the required option and then push and release
the MENU button.
4. When accessing the “Time” sub-menu item, briefly
push and release the MENU button and “hours” will
flash on the display.
5. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
button for
6. Briefly push and release the MENU button and “minutes” will flash on the display.
7. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
button for
setting rapidly. Save the setting by briefly pushing
the button when you approach the required setting.
• Briefly push and release the MENU button to return
to the “Time” sub-function.
• When accessing the “Mode” submenu, briefly push
and release the MENU button. The previously set
display format will flash on the display.
• Push and release the UP
select “24h” or “12h.”
or DOWN
button to
When you have selected the required settings, briefly
push and release the MENU button to go back to the
NOTE:
Time, Mode sub-menu screen, or push and hold the
• The setting will increase or decrease by one unit each MENU button (approximately one second) to go back to
or DOWN
button is pushed. the main screen without storing the settings.
time the UP
Push and hold the button to increase/decrease the
4
168 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
6. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
setting.
This function may be used to set the date (day - month year).
NOTE: The setting will increase or decrease by one unit
or DOWN
button is pushed.
each time the UP
To change, the date proceed as follows:
Push and hold the UP
or DOWN
button to
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and increase/decrease the setting rapidly. Save the setting
or DOWN
button to highlight by briefly pushing the button when you approach the
release the UP
Date, push and release the MENU button and Year required setting.
will begin to flash.
• Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
setting.
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
main screen without storing the settings.
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button and
Set Date
“month” will flash on the display.
4. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
See Radio (Repeat Audio Information)
button for With this function active, the EVIC display shows information relevant to the sound system.
5. Briefly push and release the MENU button and “day” • Radio: tuned radio station frequency, automatic tuning
will flash on the display.
activation or AutoStore.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 169
• CD audio, CD MP3: track number.
Speed Display
To activate (On) or to deactivate (Off) the sound system When this function is activated the cluster will display
the vehicle speed (MPH or km/h).
info displaying, proceed as follows:
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and To activate (On) or to deactivate (Off) the speed display
or Down
button to highlight feature, proceed as follows:
release the UP
See Radio and push and release the MENU button.
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
or DOWN
button to highlight
release the UP
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
Speed
Display.
Push
and
release
the MENU button
setting.
to enter the Speed Display MENU.
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
or DOWN
button to
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU 2. Push and release the UP
select display deactivation “Off”, “MPH” or “km/
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
h.”
main screen without storing the settings.
If the radio has BLUE&ME™, refer to the appropriate 3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
“BLUE&ME™ Radio Supplement” for further informabutton (approximately one second) to go back to the
tion.
main screen.
4
170 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Autoclose
Units (Set Units)
With this function active, the doors will automatically This function may be used to set the measurement unit in
lock at when the vehicle’s speed exceeds 15 mph three submenus: “Distance,” “Temperature” and “Fuel
(24 km/h).
Economy, and Tire Pressure.”
To change the setting proceed as follows:
To set the required unit, proceed as follows:
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push the 1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
or DOWN
button to highlight Autoclose.
or DOWN
button to highlight
UP
release the UP
Push and release the MENU button to enter AutoUnits. Push and release the MENU button to enter
close MENU.
Units MENU.
2. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
button for 2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
navigate the three sub-menus.
button to
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back 3. Select the required sub-menu and then briefly push
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
and release the MENU button.
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
main screen without storing the settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 171
4. When accessing the “Distance” submenu, briefly push 1. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
and release the MENU button. Either “mi” or “km”
setting.
will appear on the display (according to the previous
2. Briefly push and release the MENU button to return to
setting).
the sub-menu.
or DOWN
button for
5. Push and release the UP
3. When accessing the “Temperature” submenu: briefly
setting.
push and release the MENU button. Either “°F” or
6. Briefly push and release the MENU button to return to
“°C” will appear on the display (according to the
the sub-menu.
previous setting).
or DOWN
button for
7. When accessing the “Fuel Economy” submenu, briefly 4. Push and release the UP
setting.
push and release the MENU button. Either “mpg,”
“km/l ” or “l/100km” will appear on the display
5. Briefly push and release the MENU button to return to
(according to the previous setting).
the Tire Pressure — PSI/KPA sub-menu.
If the distance unit set is “mi,” the fuel economy unit will
When you have made the required settings, briefly push
be displayed in “mpg.”
and release the MENU button to go back to the sub-menu
If the distance unit set is “km,” the fuel economy unit will screen, or push and hold the MENU button (approximately one second) to go back to the main screen without
be displayed in either km/l or l/100km.
storing the settings.
4
172 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Language (Selecting The Language)
Buzzer Volume (Adjusting The Failure/Warning
The messages can be displayed in the following lan- Buzzer Volume)
guages: Italian, English, Turkce, Nederlands, Spanish, With this function the volume of the buzzer accompanying any failure/warning indication can be adjusted to
French, Dutch, Polish, Brasilian.
one of eight volume levels.
To set the required language, proceed as follows:
To adjust the volume proceed as follows:
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
or DOWN
button to highlight 1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
release the UP
Language. Push and release the MENU button to
or DOWN
button, then highrelease the UP
enter the Language MENU.
light the Buzzer Volume. Push and release the
MENU button to enter the Buzzer Volume MENU.
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
setting.
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
setting.
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU 3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
main screen without storing the settings.
main screen without storing the settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 173
Button Volume (Button Volume Adjustment)
Belt Buzzer (Buzzer Activation For S.B.R.
This function may be used to adjust the volume of the Indication)
or This function will only be displayed after a FIAT Group
beep accompanying the buttons. MENU, UP
DOWN
buttons can be adjusted according to 8 Automobiles dealership has deactivated the S.B.R. syslevels.
tem.
To adjust the volume, proceed as follows:
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and This function may be used to activate / deactivate the
or DOWN
button to highlight Daytime Running Lamps.
release the UP
the Buzzer Volume, push and release the MENU Proceed as follows to switch this function on or off:
button.
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
or DOWN
button to highlight
release the Up
setting.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL). Push and release
the MENU button to enter the DRL MENU.
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
to the menu screen, or push and hold the MENU
2. Briefly push and release the MENU button. “On” or
button (approximately one second) to go back to the
“Off” will flash on the display (according to previous
main screen without storing the settings.
setting).
4
174 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
3. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
button for To set the required unit, proceed as follows:
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button to display
the two sub-menus.
4. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
to the menu screen, or push and hold the button
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button to
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
navigate the two sub-menus.
screen without storing the settings.
3. Select the required sub-menu and then briefly push
GSI (Gear Shift Indicator)
and release the MENU button.
This function may be used to set the Gear Shift Indicator
or DOWN
button for
in two submenus: “Fuel Econ On” and “Fuel Econ Off.” 4. Push and release the UP
setting.
• Fuel Econ On – turns on a fuel economy upshift light
5. Briefly push and release the MENU button to return to
in the instrument cluster, for optimum fuel economy,
the sub-menu.
when operating in base driving mode.
When you have made the required settings, briefly push
• Fuel Econ Off – the fuel economy upshift light is
and release the MENU button to go back to the sub-menu
disabled.
screen, or push and hold the MENU button (approximately one second) to go back to the main screen without
storing the settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 175
Hill Start Assist
Tire Pressure
This function is used when starting a vehicle from a stop
on a hill. Hill Start Assist maintains the same level of
brake pressure the driver applied for a short period of
time after the foot has been removed from the brake
pedal.
This function will be used to display the tire pressures
individually for all four tires by location.
Proceed as follows:
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
or DOWN
button to highlight
release the UP
Proceed as follows to switch this function on or off:
the Tire Pressure. Push and release the MENU
button to enter the Tire Pressure MENU.
1. Briefly push and release the MENU button. Push and
or DOWN
button to highlight
release the UP
2. Push and release the UP or DOWN button to scroll
the Hill Start Assist. Push and release the MENU
through all four tire pressure value locations.
button to enter the Hill Start Assist MENU.
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
to the menu screen, or push and hold the button
setting.
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
3. Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back
screen.
to the menu screen, or push and hold the button
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
screen without storing the settings.
4
176 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Lock
Exit Menu
When Unlock Driver Door is selected, only the driver’s
door will unlock on the first push of the Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) transmitter UNLOCK button. When Unlock
Drivers Door is selected, you must push the RKE transmitter UNLOCK button twice to unlock the passenger
door. When All Doors is selected, both of the doors will
unlock on the first push of the RKE transmitter UNLOCK
button. To make your selection, push and release the
SELECT button until “Unlock Driver Door” or “All
Doors” appears.
This function closes the initial menu screen.
Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back to
the main screen.
button to return to the first
Push and release the
menu option (Speed Beep).
Push and release the
button to return to the last
menu option (Daylights).
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 177
SALES CODE (RAB) RADIO
If the radio has BLUE&ME™, refer to the appropriate
“BLUE&ME™ User’s Manual” for further information.
The instructions for use are given below and we recommend you to read them carefully.
Suggestions
Road Safety
Please, learn how to use all different radio functions (e.g.
store stations) before beginning to drive.
Reception Conditions
RAB Radio
Introduction
The radio has been designed according to the specifications of the passenger compartment, with a personalized
design to match the style of the dashboard.
Reception conditions change constantly while driving.
Reception may be interfered with by the presence of
mountains, buildings or bridges, or when you are far
away from the broadcaster.
4
178 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
WARNING!
Having the volume turned up high can cause the
driver to not be able to hear important traffic sounds,
i.e. sirens, horns, etc. Failure to hear traffic sounds
and other important audible information can result
in serious injury or death. Always adjust the volume
so that you can still hear background noises.
Care And Maintenance
Clean the cover with a soft antistatic cloth only. Cleaning
and polishing products could damage the surface.
CDs
• Clean every CD thoroughly removing any finger
marks or dust using a soft cloth. Hold CDs by the
outside and clean them from the middle outwards.
• Never use chemicals (e.g. antistatics or thinners or
sprays) for cleaning as they could damage the surface
of the CDs.
• After listening to them place CDs back in their boxes to
prevent them from being damaged.
• Do not expose CDs to direct sunlight, high temperatures or moisture for long periods.
• Do not stick labels on the CD surface or write on the
recorded surface with pencils or pens.
The presence of dirt, scratches or distortions on the CDs • Do not use CDs that are very scratched, flawed,
could cause skipping and poor sound quality while it is
distorted, etc. Using discs like these will result in
playing. For optimal playback conditions, follow these
malfunctions or damage to the player.
guidelines:
• Only use branded CDs.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 179
• The use of original CD media is required for the best • The CD player is capable of reading most compression
quality audio production. Correct operation is not
systems currently in use, following the development of
these systems, the reading of all compression formats
guaranteed when CD-R/RW media are used that were
is not guaranteed.
not correctly burned and/or with a maximum capacity
above 650 Mb.
Technical Specifications
• Do not use commercially available protective sheets The complete system consists of:
for CDs or discs, with stabilizers, etc. as they could get
stuck in the internal mechanism and damage the disc. • Two 165 mm diameter midwoofer speakers, one
speaker in each of the front doors.
• If a copy-protected CD is used, it may take a few
seconds before the system starts to play it. The CD • Two 22 mm diameter tweeter speakers, one speaker in
each of the front pillars.
player cannot be guaranteed to play all protected
discs. The fact that the CD is protected from being • Two 100 mm diameter full range speakers, one speaker
copied is often shown in very small letters or is
in each of the rear side panels.
difficult to read on the actual CD cover where it may
be, for example, “COPY CONTROL,” “COPY PRO- • Antenna on the car roof.
TECTED,” “THIS CD CANNOT BE PLAYED ON A • Radio with CD/MP3 player.
PC/MAC.”
4
180 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
With Alpine Premium Audio system (if equipped):
• Antenna on the car roof.
• Two 165 mm diameter midwoofer speakers.
• Radio with CD/MP3 player.
• Two 11 mm tweeter speakers in the front pillars.
With BEATS Premium Audio system (if equipped):
• Two 100 mm full range speakers, one speaker in each • A subwoofer in the trunk on the left-hand side panel.
of the rear side panels.
• An amplifier in the trunk on the right-hand side panel.
Quick Guide
Radio Controls
BUTTON
TUNER
GENERAL FUNCTIONS
On
Off
AM, FM, SAT (if equipped) source selection
MODE
Short button push
Short button push
Short repeated button push
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 181
BUTTON
A-B-C
MEDIA
BUTTON
(Mute/Pause
Button)
AUDIO
GENERAL FUNCTIONS
Cycles A, B, C presets for AM, FM, SAT (if
equipped)
CD/AUX/Media Player (if equipped and
present) source selection
MODE
Short repeated button push
Short repeated button push
GENERAL FUNCTIONS
Volume
activation/deactivation
(Mute/Pause)
MODE
Short button push
Audio adjustments: low tones
(BASS), high tones (TREBLE), left/
right balance (BALANCE), front/
rear balance (FADER)
Menu activation: short button push
or
Adjustment type selection: push
Adjustment of values: push
or
4
182 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
BUTTON
(Information
Button)
MENU
GENERAL FUNCTIONS
Song, Artist, Album, Genre, Playlist, Folder information (if available) in CD, Media Player and Satellite (if so equipped); Toggles
RBDS information in FM
Advanced functions adjustment
+Vol/–Vol
Volume adjustment
BUTTON
RADIO FUNCTIONS
Radio Station Search:
• Automatic Search
• Manual Search
MODE
Menu activation: short button push
or
Adjustment type selection: push
Adjustment of values: push
or
Push + button: volume increase
Push – button: volume decrease
MODE
Automatic search: push buttons
or
(long push for fast forward)
Manual search: push buttons
or
(long
push for fast forward)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 183
BUTTON
12345
RADIO FUNCTIONS
Current radio station storing
Stored station recall
BUTTON
CD FUNCTIONS
CD ejection
Previous/next track play
CD track fast forward/rewind
Previous/next folder play (for CD-MP3)
MODE
Long button push for memory preset 1 to 5
respectively
Short button push for memory preset 1 to 5
respectively
MODE
Short button push
Short button push
Long button push
Short button push
4
or
or
or
184 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
General Information
CD Section
The radio offers the following functions:
• Track selection (forward/backward)
Radio Section
• Fast forward/rewind through tracks
• PLL tuning with FM/AM bands
• CD Display function: display of track number and on
mp3 discs (song title, artist) and time elapsed since
start of the track
• RBDS (Radio Broadcast Data System)
• Automatic/manual station tuning
• FM Multipath detector
• Manual storing of 25 stations (base radio) and 40
stations (if equipped with Satellite): 15 on FM band (5
on FMA, 5 on FMB, 5 on FMC), 10 on AM band (5 on
AMA, 5 on AMB), 15 on Satellite Band - if equipped (5
on SATA, 5 on SATB, 5 on SATC)
• Playing Audio CD, CD-R and CD-RW
CAUTION!
On multimedia CDs, besides audio tracks, there are
data tracks too. Playing this type of CD could cause
hissing at a volume that could damage the speakers.
CD/MP3 Section
• SPEED VOLUME function: Customer selectable automatic volume adjustment depending on the car speed • MP3-Info function (ID3-TAG)
• Automatic Stereo/Mono selection
• Folder selection (previous/next)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 185
• Track selection (forward/backward)
Functions And Adjustments
• Fast forward/rewind through tracks
Turning The Car Radio On
(ON/OFF) button
• MP3 Display function: display of folder name, ID3- The car radio comes on when the
TAG information, time elapsed since the start of the is pushed briefly.
track, name of the file
When the car radio is turned on and the on volume limit
is on, the volume is limited to a setting of five even if it
• Playing audio or data CD, CD-R and CD-RW
had been set higher when previously used.
Audio Section
Turning The Car Radio Off
• Mute/pause function
Push the
(ON/OFF) button to turn the radio off.
• Soft mute function
Selecting The Radio Functions
• Loudness function
By pushing the TUNER button briefly and repeatedly, the
• Graphic 7 band equalizer (if equipped)
following audio sources can be selected cyclically:
• Separate bass/treble tone adjustment
• Right/left channel balancing
• Front/rear fader
• AM, FM and Satellite Bands (if equipped)
4
186 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
When the volume level is changed using the dedicated
By briefly pushing the MEDIA button, the CD audio controls, the Mute function is deactivated and the volume is adjusted to the new level selected.
source can be selected (only if a CD is loaded).
Audio Adjustment
Volume Adjustment
Selecting The CD Function
To adjust the volume, push the buttons +Vol or –Vol to The functions that can be selected from the audio menu
change depending on the context: AM/FM/MEDIA/
increase/decrease the volume.
SATELLITE.
Mute/Pause Function
Push the AUDIO button briefly to change the Audio
Push the
button briefly to activate the MUTE func- functions. After the AUDIO button is first pushed, the
tion. The volume will gradually decrease and the display will show the Bass level value for the source
wording “TUNER Mute” will be shown on the display activated at that time (e.g. in FM mode the display will
(in radio mode) or “CD Pause” (in CD mode).
show the wording “FM Bass +2”).
Push the
button again to deactivate the MUTE Use the buttons
or
to scroll through the Menu
function. The volume will gradually increase until it functions. To change the setting of the selected funcreaches the previously set level.
or
buttons.
tion, use the
The current status of the selected function appears on the
display.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 187
The functions managed by the Audio Menu are:
Tone Adjustment
• BASS (Bass adjustment)
Proceed as follows:
• MIDRANGE (Midrange adjustment)
1. Push the AUDIO button.
• TREBLE (Treble adjustment)
or
button to select “Bass,” “Mid2. Push the
range” or “Treble” in the AUDIO menu.
• BALANCE (right/left Balance adjustment)
• FADER (front/rear Balance adjustment)
3. Push the
or
button to increase/decrease the
bass or treble adjustments.
• LOUDNESS — if equipped (Loudness function By pushing the
or
buttons briefly, the levels will
activation/deactivation)
change progressively. By pushing them down longer,
• EQUALIZER — if equipped (activation and selection the levels will change quickly.
of factory equalization adjustments)
Balance Adjustment
• USER EQUALIZER — if equipped (customized equal- Proceed as follows:
ization adjustment)
1. Push the AUDIO button.
or
2. Push the
AUDIO menu.
button to set “Balance” in the
4
188 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
button to increase the sound from the By pushing the
or
buttons briefly, the levels will
3. Push the
left speakers or the
button to increase the sound change progressively. By pushing them down longer,
from the right speakers.
the levels will change quickly.
By pushing the
or
buttons briefly, the levels will Select the value “0” to set the right and left audio outputs
change progressively. By pushing them down longer, at the same level.
the levels will change quickly.
Loudness Function — If Equipped
Select the value “0” to set the right and left audio outputs The Loudness function improves the volume of the
at the same level.
sound while listening at low volumes, increasing the bass
Fader Adjustment
Proceed as follows:
and treble.
To activate/deactivate this function, select the “Loudness” setting in the AUDIO menu. The condition of the
1. Push the AUDIO button.
function (on or off) is shown on the display for a few
or
button to set “Fader” in the seconds by the wording “Loudness On” or “Loudness
2. Push the
AUDIO menu.
Off”.
3. Push the
button to increase the sound coming
button to increase
from the rear speakers or the
the sound coming from the front speakers.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 189
Preset/User/Classic/Rock/Jazz Functions — If
Equipped
When one of the equalizer adjustments is activated the
wording “EQ” lights up.
The built-in equalizer can be activated/deactivated.
When the equalizer function is off, the audio settings can
only be changed by adjusting the “Bass” and “Treble”
settings, whereas when the function is on, the acoustic
curves can be adjusted. To deactivate the equalizer, select
the “EQ Preset” function in the audio menu.
User EQ Settings Function — If Equipped
To set a personalized equalizer adjustment:
1. Push the AUDIO button.
2. Use the
or
buttons to set EQ function.
or
buttons to select ⬙EQ User.⬙
To activate the equalizer, use the AUDIO button to select 3. Use
one of the adjustments:
4. Push the MENU button to start adjusting equalizer.
• “EQ User” (adjustment of 7 equalizer bands that can
5. On the display a seven bar graph will appear, in which
be changed by the user)
each bar represents a frequency. Select the bar to be
• “Classic” (equalizer preset for optimal classic music
or
buttons. The selected
adjusted by using the
sound)
bar will start to flash and it can be adjusted using
or
buttons.
• “Rock” (equalizer preset for optimal rock and pop
music sound)
6. To store the setting, push the MENU or AUDIO
• “Jazz” (equalizer preset for optimal jazz music sound)
buttons.
4
190 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Menu
• SiriusXM Telephone Number
MENU Button Functions
• System Reset
Push the MENU button briefly to activate the Menu • Speed Volume
function.
• On Volume Limit
or
buttons to scroll through the menu
Use the
Push the MENU button again to exit the Menu function.
functions. To change the setting of the selected funcor
buttons.
tion, use the
Speed Volume Function — If Equipped
The current status of the selected function appears on the This function automatically adapts the volume level to
the speed of the car, turning up the volume when the
display.
speed increases to maintain the ratio with the noise level
The functions managed by the Menu are:
inside the passenger compartment. To activate/
deactivate the function, use the buttons. The wording
• Speech Volume
“Speed volume” appears on the display, followed by the
• Aux Audio Offset
current status of the function:
• Radio Off
• Off: function deactivated
• Sat ID
• Low: function activated (low sensitivity)
• High: function activated (high sensitivity)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 191
• “On volume limit: off” – The radio will come on at the
same volume as before it was switched off. The
This function makes it possible to activate/deactivate the
volume level can be between 0 and 40.
maximum volume limit when turning the radio on.
or
to change the setting.
Use the buttons
The display shows the function status:
NOTE:
• “On volume limit: on” – when the radio is turned on
the volume level will be:
• Using the Menu it is only possible to adjust the
activation/deactivation of the function and not the
– If the volume level is equal to or higher than the
minimum or maximum volume value.
maximum value, the radio will come on at the
maximum volume.
• If the battery charge is too low, the volume cannot be
– If the volume level is between the minimum and
adjusted between the minimum and the maximum
maximum values, the radio will come on at the
level.
same volume as before it was switched off.
Radio Off Function
– If the volume level is equal to or lower than the
minimum value, the radio will come on at the This function makes it possible to set the radio switching
off mode by choosing between two methods.
minimum volume.
On Volume Limit
4
192 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The chosen mode appears on the display:
on the display. At the end of the operation, the source
does not change and the previous situation will be
displayed.
• “Radio off: 00 min” — The radio turns off in connection with the ignition key; the radio is turned automatically off as soon as the key is turned to the STOP Radio
position.
(Tuner) Introduction
• “Radio off: 20 min” — The radio turns off indepen- When the car radio is turned on, the last function that
dently from the ignition key; the radio remains on for was selected before turning it off (Radio, CD, CD MP3,
a maximum period of 20 minutes after the key has AUX) is activated.
been turned to the STOP position.
To select the Radio function when another audio source is
System Reset Function
being listened to, briefly push the TUNER button.
This function is used to restore all settings to the factory
Once the Radio mode has been activated, the display will
values. The options are:
show the name (RBDS stations only) or the frequency of
• NO — No restore intervention.
the selected radio station, the frequency band selected
(e.g. FMA) and the preset button number (e.g. P1).
• YES — The default parameters will be restored. During such operation, the wording “Resetting” appears
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 193
Frequency Band Selection
• 15 in SAT (if so equipped) (5 SATA, 5 SATB, 5 SATC)
With the Radio mode active, press the FM or AM tuner To listen to a preset station, select the desired frequency
button briefly and repeatedly to select the desired recep- band and then briefly push the corresponding preset
tion band.
button (from 1 to 5).
Each time the button is pressed the following bands are By pushing the preset button for more than two seconds,
selected cyclically:
the tuned station will be stored. Pushing the A-B-C
button will change between the preset memory group in
• AM, FM or SAT (if equipped)
the current frequency band.
Each band is highlighted by the corresponding wordings
Automatic Tuning
on the display. The radio will be tuned to last station
Briefly push the
or
button to start the automatic
selected on the respective frequency band.
tuning search for the next station that can be received
Preset Buttons
in the selected direction.
The buttons numbered from 1 to 5 are used to set the
If the
or
button is pushed for longer, the rapid
following pre-selections:
search is started. When the button is released, the
• 15 in the FM band (5 in FMA, 5 in FMB, 5 in FMC)
tuner will stop on the next station that can be received.
• 10 in the AM band (5 in AMA, 5 in AMB)
4
194 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Manual Tuning
This is used to manually search for stations in the
preselected band.
Select the desired frequency band and then push briefly
or
button to start the search in
and repeatedly the
or
button is pushed
the desired direction. If the
longer, the fast search starts and then stops when the
button is released.
Stereophonic Broadcasters
If the incoming signal is weak, the reproduction is
automatically switched from Stereo to Mono.
SiriusXM Satellite Radio — If Equipped
SiriusXM Satellite Radio
With over 130 channels, SiriusXM Satellite Radio brings
you more of what you love. Get 69 channels of 100%
commercial-free music, plus all of your favorite sports,
news, talk and entertainment. Hear every NFL game,
every NASCAR race, college sports and more. The biggest and most compelling names in talk with Howard
Stern and Martha Stewart, laugh-out-loud comedy with
Jamie Foxx’s The Foxxhole and Blue Collar Comedy, plus
kids’ programming, world-class news, local traffic and
weather. All of this with crystal clear, coast-to-coast
coverage. Everything worth listening to is now on
SiriusXM. A one-year SiriusXM Satellite Radio subscription is included. SiriusXM and all related marks and
logos are trademarks of SiriusXM Radio Inc. and its
subsidiaries. SiriusXM Radio requires a subscription,
sold separately after trial subscription included with
vehicle purchase. Prices and programming are provided
by SiriusXM and are subject to change. Subscriptions
governed by Terms & Conditions available at
www.siriusxm.com/customeragreement. SiriusXM Radio U.S. service only available to those at least 18 years of
age in the 48 contiguous United States, D.C., and PR.
Service available in Canada; see www.siriusxm.ca.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 195
SiriusXM Satellite Radio Program Types
Program Types can be selected by pushing the
or
buttons. The Program Type will change to the next
category and the radio will then tune to first station in
or
buttons will tune
that program type. Pushing
to only the stations in that program type.
Re-Subscribe To SiriusXM Satellite Radio
New vehicle purchasers or lessees will receive a free
limited time subscription to SiriusXM Satellite Radio
with their radio. Following expiration of the free services,
it will be necessary to access the information on the
Subscription Information screen in order to re-subscribe.
Press the UP/DOWN button to scroll through the Menu
Pushing the
or
buttons until ⬙All⬙ is displayed
Functions, and the Left/Right button to change the
will allow normal tuning to all stations.
selected Set-up Menu function.
The Program Types available are: All, Pop, Rock,
Write down the Electronic Serial Number (ESN) for your
Electronic/Dance, Hip-Hop/R&B, Country, Christian,
receiver. To retrieve the Electronic Serial Number of
Jazz/Standards, Classical, Latin/World, Sports, EnterSiriusXM Satellite Receiver Module tune to Channel 0.
tainment, Talk, News, NPR, Comedy, Family & Health,
Make sure that when the order is placed, the ESN are
Religion, Traffic/Weather.
correct. If any of the ESN numbers are not entered
You can find the SiriusXM current terms and conditions correctly, then the SiriusXM subscription will not be able
at www.siriusxm.com.
to be transferred to the new radio and will not be active
when installed in the customer’s vehicle. To reactivate
4
196 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
your service, either call the number listed on the display Sirius Subscription Issues When Replacing A
or visit the provider online.
Sirius Radio
CAUTION!
Neither SIRIUS nor FIAT is responsible for any
errors in accuracies in the SIRIUS data services or its
use in vehicles.
When a radio needs to be replaced, the Dealer will need
the SIRIUS information to order a new radio (even if the
SIRIUS subscription has lapsed). The ESN number contains 12 digits.
The following are instructions for retrieving the Electronic Serial Number (ESN) from FIAT 500 NAFTA model
SiriusXM and all related marks and logos are trademarks
radios:
of SiriusXM Radio Inc. and its subsidiaries. SiriusXM
Radio requires a subscription, sold separately after trial To retrieve the ESN of SIRIUS Satellite Receiver Module
subscription included with vehicle purchase. Prices and tune to Channel 0. Make sure that when the order is
programming are provided by SiriusXM and are subject placed, the ESN are correct. If any of the ESN numbers
to change. Subscriptions governed by Terms & Condi- are not entered correctly, then the SIRIUS subscription
tions
available
at
www.siriusxm.com/ will not be able to be transferred to the new radio and
customeragreement. SiriusXM Radio U.S. service only will not be active when installed in the customer’s
available to those at least 18 years of age in the 48 vehicle.
contiguous United States, D.C., & PR. www.siriusxm.com.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 197
Satellite Radio Antenna — If Equipped
CD Player Selection
The antenna for the satellite radio is mounted on the roof
of the vehicle. Do not place items on the roof around the
roof top antenna location. Objects placed within the line
of sight of the antenna will cause decreased performance.
Larger luggage items should be placed as far from the
antenna as possible. Do not place items directly on or
above the antenna.
To activate the CD player built into the equipment,
proceed as follows:
CD Player
Introduction
• Load a CD with the equipment switched on. The first
track will start to play.
Or
• If a CD has already been loaded, turn on the radio and
then briefly push the MEDIA button to select the “CD”
function mode. The last track listened to will start to
play.
This chapter describes the operation of the CD player
only. To operate the radio, refer to the description in the It is advisable to use original CDs to ensure optimal
playing. If CD-R/RWs are used, we recommend using
“Functions and Adjustments” chapter.
good quality media that are burned at the slowest speed
possible.
4
198 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
If the CD is not removed from the radio, it will automatiTo load the CD, insert it gently into the slot to activate the cally be reloaded about 20 seconds later but will not
motorized loading system, which will position it cor- resume playing until the ⬙MEDIA⬙ button is pushed to
select the CD mode. The radio will switch to the last
rectly.
source prior to CD mode.
The CD can be loaded with the radio off and the ignition
key turned to ON/RUN. In this case, the radio will The CD cannot be ejected if the radio is off.
remain off. When the radio is turned on, the last source Possible Error Messages
listened to before being switched off, will be activated.
If the loaded CD cannot be read (e.g. a CD ROM has been
When a CD is inserted, the display will show the symbol inserted or the CD is inserted the wrong way or there is
“CD” and the wording “CD Reading.” They will remain a reading error) the display shows the wording “CD Disc
displayed for the whole time required for the radio to error.”
read the CD. When this time has elapsed the radio
The CD will then be ejected and the audio source
automatically starts playing the first track.
activated before the CD mode selection will be heard.
button with the radio turned on, to
Push the
A CD which cannot be read will not be ejected until these
activate the motorized CD ejection system. After ejecfunctions are over. At the end, with the CD mode
tion, the last audio source listened to before playing
activated, the display will show the wording “CD Disc
the CD will be heard.
error” for a few seconds and then the CD will be ejected.
CD Loading/Ejecting
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 199
Display Information
Track Fast Forward/Rewind
When the CD player is operating, information will ap- Keep the
button pushed down to fast forward the
button pushed down to
pear on the display with the following meaning:
selected track and keep the
fast rewind the track. The fast forward/rewind will
• “Track 5” indicates the CD track number.
stop once the button is released.
• “03:42” indicates the time elapsed since the start of the
Pause Function
track (if the relevant Menu function is activated).
To pause the CD player, push the
button. The wordTrack Selection
ing “CD Pause” appears on the display.
Briefly push the
button to play the previous CD
To resume listening to the track, push the
button
track and the
button to play the next track. The
again.
tracks are selected cyclically: the first track is selected
after the last track and vice versa.
CD MP3 Player
If the track has been played for more than 3 seconds,
button, starts the track again from the
pushing the
beginning. In this case, if you want to play the
button twice consecuprevious track, push the
tively.
Introduction
This chapter describes the operation of the CD MP3
player.
NOTE: Layer-3 audio decoding technology is licensed
from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson multimedia.
4
200 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• The music files should have the extension “.mp3” or
“.wma” files with a different extension will not be
In addition to playing regular audio CDs, the radio is also
reproduced.
enabled to play CDROMs on which compressed audio
files have been recorded in an MP3 format.
• The sampling frequencies that can be reproduced are:
44.1 kHz, stereo (from 96 to 320 kbit/s) – 22.05 kHz,
To guarantee optimal reproduction, it is advisable to use
mono or stereo (from 32 to 80 kbit/s).
good quality CDs burned at the lowest speed possible.
MP3 Mode
• Tracks with a variable bit-rate can be reproduced.
The files on an MP3 CD are structured in folders that
create lists of all the folders containing MP3 tracks NOTE: The track names must not include the following
(folders or subfolders are all on the same level). The characters: spaces, ‘ (apostrophes), ( and ) (open and close
folders that do not contain MP3 tracks cannot be selected. brackets). During the burning of a MP3 CD, make sure
that the names of the files do not contain these characters;
The specifications and operating conditions for playing
if not, the radio will not be able to play the tracks
MP3 files are the following:
involved.
• The CD-ROMs used should be burned in accordance
Selecting MP3 Sessions With Hybrid Discs
with ISO standard 9660.
If a hybrid disc is inserted (Mixed Mode, Enhanced,
CD-Extra) also containing MP3 files, the radio automatically starts playing the audio session. It is possible to
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 201
move to the MP3 session while playing by keeping the Selection Of Next/Previous Folder
CD button pressed for more than two seconds.
Push the
button to select a next folder or the
button to select the previous folder. The display
NOTE: When the function is activated the radio may take
a few seconds to start playing. While checking the disc will show the number of the folder.
the display will show “CD Reading.” If no MP3 files are The folders are selected cyclically. The first folder is
detected, the radio will resume playing the audio session selected after the last folder and vice versa.
from the point where it was interrupted.
If no other folder/track is selected in the next two
Display Information
seconds, the first track on the new folder will be played.
ID3–Tag Information Display
After the last track in a folder is played, the next folder
In addition to the information relating to the time will be played.
elapsed, folder name and file name, the radio is also
Structure Of The Folders
capable of displaying ID3–TAG information relating to
The radio with MP3 player:
Title Track, Artist and Author.
When one of the ID3-TAG pieces of information is chosen • Recognizes only the folders that effectively contain
MP3 format files.
to be displayed (Title, Artist, Album) and this information has not been recorded for the track played, the text
⬙UNKNOWN⬙ will be displayed for that field.
4
202 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• If the MP3 files on a CD-ROM are structured in CD Player
sub-folders their structure is compressed to a single The CD Does Not Play:
level structure, where the sub-folders are taken to the
The CD is dirty. Clean the CD.
level of the main folders.
The CD is scratched. Try using another CD.
Troubleshooting
General
The CD Can Not Be Loaded:
Sound Volume Low
A CD is already loaded. Press the
the CD.
button and remove
The Fader function should be adjusted to the values “F”
(front) only to prevent the reduction in radio output MP3 File Reading
power and the cancelling of the volume if the Fader level Track Skips While Playing Mp3 Files:
adjustment is equal to R+9.
The CD is scratched or dirty.
Source Can Not Be Selected
The Duration Of The Mp3 Tracks Is Not Correctly
Nothing has been loaded. Load the CD or the MP3 CD to Displayed:
be listened to.
In some cases (due to the recording mode) the duration of
the MP3 tracks can be displayed incorrectly.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 203
Operating Instructions — Hands-Free Phone
Refer to the appropriate “BLUE&ME™ User’s Manual”
for further information.
Personal/Portable Navigation Device (PND)
A Personal/Portable Navigation Device (PND) is available as optional equipment for this vehicle, refer to the
Navigation User Guide for further information.
4
iPod®/USB/MEDIA PLAYER CONTROL — IF
EQUIPPED
This feature allows an iPod® or external USB device to be
USB/AUX Port
plugged into the USB or AUX port, located in the center
1 — Auxiliary Cable Jack
console.
2 — USB Connector
Refer to the appropriate Blue&Me™ radio User’s Manual
for iPod® or external USB device support capability.
204 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The right-hand control is a rocker-type switch with a
The remote sound system controls are located on the rear pushbutton in the center and controls the volume and
surface of the steering wheel. Reach behind the wheel to mode of the sound system. Pushing the top of the rocker
switch will increase the volume, and pushing the bottom
access the switches.
of the rocker switch will decrease the volume.
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS
Pushing the center button will make the radio switch
between the various modes available (AM/FM/SAT/
CD/AUX/Media Player, etc.) and can also be used to
select/enter an item while scrolling through menu.
The left-hand control is a rocker-type switch with a
pushbutton in the center. The function of the left-hand
control is different depending on which mode you are in.
The following describes the left-hand control operation in
each mode.
Remote Sound System Controls (Back View Of Steering
Wheel)
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 205
Radio Operation
Operating Instructions — Hands-Free Phone (If
Equipped)
Pushing the top of the switch will “Seek” up for the next
listenable station and pushing the bottom of the switch Refer to the appropriate Blue&Me™ User’s Manual for
further information.
will “Seek” down for the next listenable station.
The button located in the center of the left-hand control CD/DVD DISC MAINTENANCE
will tune to the next preset station that you have proTo keep a CD/DVD in good condition, take the following
grammed in the radio preset button.
precautions:
CD Player Operation
1. Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching the
Pushing the top of the switch once will go to the next
surface.
track on the CD. Pushing the bottom of the switch once
will go to the beginning of the current track, or to the 2. If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth,
wiping from center to edge.
beginning of the previous track if it is within one second
after the current track begins to play.
3. Do not apply paper or tape to the disc; avoid scratchIf you push the switch up or down twice, it plays the
second track; three times, it will play the third, etc.
ing the disc.
4
206 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
4. Do not use solvents such as benzene, thinner, cleaners, RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
or anti-static sprays.
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in
your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from
5. Store the disc in its case after playing.
your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
6. Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
7. Do not store the disc where temperatures may become not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
too high.
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
NOTE: If you experience difficulty in playing a particular turned down or off during mobile phone operation.
disc, it may be damaged (e.g., scratched, reflective coating removed, a hair, moisture or dew on the disc) CLIMATE CONTROLS
oversized, or have protection encoding. Try a known
The air conditioning and heating system is designed to
good disc before considering disc player service.
make you comfortable in all types of weather.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 207
Manual Heating And Air Conditioning
1. Temperature Control
Rotate this control to regulate the temperature of the air
inside the passenger compartment. Rotating the dial to
the left into the blue area of the scale indicates cooler
temperatures, while rotating to the right into the red area
indicates warmer temperatures.
2. Blower Control
Rotate this control to regulate the amount of air forced
through the ventilation system in any mode. The blower
speed increases as you move the control to the right from
the “0” (OFF) position. There are four blower speeds.
3. Recirculation Control
Manual Temperature Control (MTC)
Rotate this control to change the system between recirThe Manual Climate controls consist of a series of rotary culation mode and outside air mode. Recirculation can be
dials and one inner push knob.
used when outside conditions such as smoke, odors,
dust, or high humidity are present.
4
208 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE:
• Continuous use of the Recirculation mode may make
the inside air stuffy and window fogging may occur.
Extended use of this mode is not recommended.
• Panel
Air is directed through the outlets in the
instrument panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct airflow.
• The use of the Recirculation mode in cold or damp NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed
weather could cause windows to fog on the inside, so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers
because of moisture buildup inside the vehicle. Se- for maximum airflow to the rear.
• Bi-Level
lect the outside air position for maximum defogging.
Air is directed through the panel and floor
• Recirculation can be used in all modes except for
outlets.
Defrost.
• Floor
• The A/C can be deselected manually without disAir is directed through the floor outlets with a
turbing the mode control selection.
small amount flowing through the defrost and
side window demister outlets.
4. Mode Control
• Mix
Rotate this control to change the system between Modes
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and
(Panel, Bi-Level, Floor, Mix, Defrost).
side window demister outlets. This setting
works best in cold or snowy conditions that
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 209
require extra heat to the windshield. This setting is
good for maintaining comfort while reducing moisture on the windshield.
• Defrost
Air is directed through the windshield and
side window demister outlets. Use this mode
with maximum blower and temperature settings for
best windshield and side window defrosting.
MAX A/C
For maximum cooling, use the A/C and recirculation
modes at the same time.
ECONOMY MODE
If economy mode is desired, push the A/C button to turn
OFF the indicator light and the A/C compressor. Then,
move the temperature control to the desired temperature.
NOTE: The air conditioning compressor operates in Mix Automatic Temperature Control (ATC)
or Defrost, even if the Air Conditioning (A/C) button is
• The Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) allows the
not pushed. This dehumidifies the air to help dry the
occupant to select a comfort settings.
windshield. To improve fuel economy, use these modes
only when necessary.
• The system provides set-and-forget operation for optimum comfort and convenience.
5. A/C Button
• The system can be controlled manually, if desired.
Push this button to engage the Air Conditioning. A light The ATC system automatically maintains the interior
will illuminate when the Air Conditioning system is comfort level desired by the occupant.
engaged.
4
210 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
2. A/C Button
Push and release to change the current Air Conditioning
(A/C) setting. Performing this function will cause the
ATC to switch into manual mode.
3. Temperature Control Up Button
Provides temperature up control. Push the button for
warmer temperature settings.
4. Blower Control Up/Down Buttons
There are 12 fixed blower speeds. The blower control
up/down buttons regulate the amount of air forced
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC)
through the system in any mode you select. The blower
1. AUTO Temperature Control (ATC) Button
speed increases as you push, or hold, the blower control
Controls airflow, temperature, distribution, and air recir- up button and decreases when you push, or hold, the
culation automatically. Push and release to select. Per- blower control down button.
forming this function will cause the ATC to switch The blower fan speed may be set to any fixed speed by
between manual mode and automatic modes. Refer to pushing the blower control up or down buttons. The fan
“Automatic Operation” for more information.
will now operate at a fixed speed until additional speeds
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 211
are selected. This allows the front occupants to control and side window demist outlets. When the defrost butthe volume of air circulated in the vehicle and cancel the ton is selected, the blower level will increase. Use Defrost
mode with maximum temperature settings for best windAUTO mode.
shield and side window defrosting and defogging. PerThe operator can also select the direction of the airflow
forming this function will cause the ATC to switch into
by selecting one of the following positions.
manual mode. If the front defrost mode is turned off the
5. Mix Mode
climate system will return the previous setting.
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side 7. Floor Mode
window demister outlets. This setting works best
Air is directed through the floor outlets with a
in cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat to the
small amount flowing through the defrost and
windshield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort
side window demister outlets. Performing this function
while reducing moisture on the windshield. Performing
this function will cause the ATC to switch into manual will cause the ATC to switch into manual mode.
mode.
8. Panel Mode
6. Front Defrost
Air is directed through the outlets in the instrument panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct
Push and release to change the current airflow
airflow.
Performing this function will cause the ATC to
setting to Defrost mode. The indicator illuminates
switch
into
manual mode.
when this feature is ON. Air comes from the windshield
4
212 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed 11. Climate Control ON/OFF Button
so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers
Push and release to turn the Climate Control ON or OFF.
for maximum airflow to the rear.
12. Recirculation Control Button
9. Bi-Level
Push and release to change the current setting. The
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
indicator illuminates when ON.
Press and release the Panel mode button and Floor
mode button to enter Bi-Level mode, the indicators NOTE: When in Defrost mode, the Recirculation button
illuminate when ON. Performing this function will cause will flash if pushed. This indicates that you can not
the ATC to switch into manual mode.
proceed to this mode due to fogging risk.
10. Temperature Control Down Button
Climate Control Functions
Provides temperature down control. Push the button for Air Conditioning (A/C)
cooler temperature settings.
The Air Conditioning (A/C) button allows the operator
NOTE: If the temperature is lowered until ⬙Lo⬙ is dis- to manually activate or deactivate the air conditioning
played, all high voltage Heating, Ventilation, and Air system. When in A/C mode with the ATC set to a cool
Conditioning (HVAC) systems are deactivated and am- temperature, dehumidified air flows through the air
bient air is circulated according to the Heating, Ventilation, and Air Conditioning (HVAC) control settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 213
outlets. If Economy mode is desired, push the A/C this button is selected. Push the button a second time to
button to turn off the A/C mode in the ATC display and turn off the Recirculation mode LED and allow outside
air into the vehicle.
deactivate the A/C system.
NOTE:
• If the system is in Mix or Defrost Mode, the A/C can
be turned off, but the A/C system shall remain active
to prevent fogging of the windows.
• If fog or mist appears on the windshield or side glass,
select Defrost mode and adjust blower speed if
needed.
Recirculation Control
NOTE: In cold weather, use of Recirculation mode may
lead to excessive window fogging. The recirculation
feature may be unavailable (indicator light shall blink) if
conditions exist that could create fogging on the inside of
the windshield. On systems with Manual Climate Controls, the Recirculation mode is not allowed in Defrost
mode to improve window clearing operation. Recirculation will be disabled automatically if this mode is selected. Attempting to use Recirculation while in this
mode will cause the LED in the control button to blink
and then turn off.
When outside air contains smoke, odors, or high humidity, or if rapid cooling is desired, you may wish to Automatic Operation
recirculate interior air by pushing the RECIRCULATION 1. Push the AUTO button on the Automatic Temperature
control button. Recirculation mode should only be used
Control (ATC) Panel, the indicator will illuminate
temporarily. The recirculation LED will illuminate when
when on.
4
214 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
2. Next, adjust the temperature you would like the
feature. Refer to the “Electronic Vehicle Information
system to maintain by adjusting the temperature conCenter (EVIC) — Customer-Programmable Features”
trol buttons. Once the desired temperature is disin this section of the manual.
played, the system will achieve and automatically
Manual Operation
maintain that comfort level.
The system allows for manual selection of blower speed,
3. When the system is set up for your comfort level, it is air distribution mode, A/C status and recirculation connot necessary to change the settings. You will experi- trol.
ence the greatest efficiency by simply allowing the
The blower fan speed can be set to any fixed speed by
system to function automatically.
adjusting the blower control. The fan will now operate at
NOTE:
a fixed speed until additional speeds are selected. This
• It is not necessary to move the temperature settings for allows the front occupants to control the volume of air
cold or hot vehicles. The system automatically adjusts circulated in the vehicle and cancel the Auto mode.
the temperature, mode and fan speed to provide The operator can also select the direction of the airflow
comfort as quickly as possible.
by selecting one of the available mode settings. A/C
• The temperature can be displayed in U.S. or Metric operation and Recirculation control can also be manually
units by selecting the US/M customer-programmable selected in Manual operation.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 215
As the temperature gets colder, it may be necessary to
direct air onto the windshield. Adjust the temperature
NOTE: Refer to the chart at the end of this section for
control and blower speed to maintain comfort. Higher
suggested control settings for various weather condiblower speeds will reduce fogging. Interior fogging on
tions.
the windshield can be quickly removed by selecting the
Defrost mode.
Window Fogging
Operating Tips
Windows will fog on the inside when the humidity inside
the vehicle is high. This often occurs in mild or cool
temperatures when it’s rainy or humid. In most cases,
turning the air conditioning (pressing the A/C button) on
will clear the fog. Adjust the temperature control, air
direction, and blower speed to maintain comfort.
Regular cleaning of the inside of the windows with a
non-filming cleaning solution (vinegar and water works
very well) will help prevent contaminates (cigarette
smoke, perfumes, etc.) from sticking to the windows.
Contaminates increase the rate of window fogging.
NOTE: Automatic Temperature Controls (ATC) will automatically adjust the climate control settings to reduce
or eliminate window fogging on the front windshield.
When this occurs, recirculation will be unavailable.
4
216 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Summer Operation
Winter Operation
NOTE: In some cases during high temperature operation, the air conditioning system performance may be
reduced. This is to help protect the engine from overheating during the high load condition.
When operating the system during the winter months,
make sure the air intake, located directly in front of the
windshield, is free of ice, slush, snow, or other obstructions.
Your air conditioning system is also equipped with an
automatic recirculation system. When the system senses
a heavy load or high heat conditions, it may use Recirculation A/C mode to provide additional comfort while
in automatic mode.
Vacation Storage
Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of service
(i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air
conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the
fresh air using the high blower setting. This will ensure
adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility
of compressor damage when the air conditioning system
is started again.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 217
Operating Tips Chart
4
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
䡵 STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
▫ Five-Speed Manual Transmission. . . . . . . . . . .226
▫ Manual Transmission — If Equipped . . . . . . .223
▫ Recommended Shift Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
▫ Automatic Transmission — If Equipped . . . . .223
▫ Downshifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
▫ Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223 䡵 AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Cold Weather Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
▫ Key Ignition Park Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Extended Park Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
▫ Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System
▫ If Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
▫ Six-Speed Automatic Transmission . . . . . .
▫ After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
▫ Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Turbocharger “Cool Down” . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
䡵 AUTOSTICK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 MANUAL TRANSMISSION — IF EQUIPPED . .226
. . .229
. . .231
. . .231
. . .231
. . .233
. . .238
5
220 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238 䡵 ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM . . . .248
䡵 DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES . . . . . . . . .239
▫ Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . .248
▫ Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
▫ Brake Assist System (BAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
▫ Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
▫ Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . .251
䡵 DRIVING THROUGH WATER . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
▫ Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
▫ Flowing/Rising Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
▫ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . .252
▫ Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
▫ ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
ESC OFF Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
䡵 POWER STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
䡵 PARKING BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
䡵 SPORT MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
▫ Manual Transmission — If Equipped . . . . . . . .246
▫ Automatic Transmission — If Equipped . . . . . .247
䡵 BRAKE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
䡵 TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN). . . . . . . . . . .260
▫ Tire Terminology And Definitions . . . . . . . . . .262
▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . .263
STARTING AND OPERATING 221
䡵 TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . .268 䡵 TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS . . . . .281
▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268 䡵 TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
(TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
▫ Base System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation . . . .271
▫ Enhanced System — If Equipped . . . . .
▫ Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
▫ Premium TPM System . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tire Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Run Flat Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
䡵 FUEL REQUIREMENTS — 1.4L Engine . .
▫ Spare Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
䡵 FUEL REQUIREMENTS — 1.4L Turbo . . .
▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
▫ Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
▫ Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . .
▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
▫ E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles . .
▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
▫ MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) . . . . . . .280
. . . . .282
. . . . .285
. . . . .288
. . . . .288
. . . . .292
. . . . .292
. . . . .293
. . . . .293
. . . . .294
. . . . .294
. . . . .294
5
222 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
▫ Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . .299
▫ Fuel System Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295 䡵 TRAILER TOWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
▫ Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . .296 䡵 RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
䡵 ADDING FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
▫ Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle . .299
▫ Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
STARTING AND OPERATING 223
STARTING PROCEDURES
Manual Transmission — If Equipped
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust both Apply the parking brake, place the shift lever in NEUinside and outside mirrors, and fasten your seat belts.
TRAL, and press the clutch pedal before starting the
vehicle. This vehicle is equipped with a clutch interlocking ignition system. It will not start unless the clutch
WARNING!
pedal is pressed to the floor.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
Automatic Transmission — If Equipped
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is The shift lever must be in the PARK or NEUTRAL
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or position before you can start the engine. Depress the
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Chil- brake pedal before shifting to any driving gear.
dren should be warned not to touch the parking
NOTE: You must press the brake pedal before shifting
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle (or out of PARK.
in a location accessible to children). A child could Normal Starting
operate power windows, other controls, or move
NOTE: Normal starting of either a cold or a warm
the vehicle.
engine is obtained without pumping or pressing the
accelerator pedal.
5
224 STARTING AND OPERATING
Turn the ignition switch to the AVV/ACC (START)
position and release it when the engine starts. If the
engine fails to start within 10 seconds, turn the ignition
switch to the STOP (OFF/LOCK) position, wait 10 to 15
seconds, then repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
Cold Weather Operation
To prevent possible engine damage while starting at low
temperatures, this vehicle will inhibit engine cranking
when the ambient temperature is less than –22° F (–30° C)
and the oil temperature sensor reading indicates an
engine block heater has not been used. An externallypowered electric engine block heater is available as
optional equipment or from your authorized dealer.
The message “plug in engine heater” will be displayed in
the instrument cluster when the ambient temperature is
below 5° F (–15° C) at the time the engine is shut off as a
reminder to avoid possible crank delays at the next cold
start.
CAUTION!
Use of the recommended oil and adhering to the
prescribed oil change intervals is important to prevent engine damage and ensure satisfactory starting
in cold conditions.
Extended Park Starting
NOTE: Extended Park condition occurs when the vehicle
has not been started or driven for at least 30 days.
1. Install a battery charger or jumper cables to the battery
to ensure a full battery charge during the crank cycle.
2. Cycle the ignition in the START position and release it
when the engine starts.
STARTING AND OPERATING 225
3. If the engine fails to start within ten seconds, cycle the If Engine Fails To Start
ignition to the STOP (OFF/LOCK) position, wait five
seconds to allow the starter to cool, then repeat the
WARNING!
Extended Park Starting procedure.
Never pour fuel or other flammable liquids into the
4. If the engine fails to start after eight attempts, allow throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to start
the starter to cool for at least 10 minutes, then repeat the vehicle. This could result in a flash fire causing
the procedure.
serious personal injury.
CAUTION!
To prevent damage to the starter, do not continuously
crank the engine for more than 10 seconds at a time.
Wait 10 to 15 seconds before trying again.
CAUTION!
• Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it
started. Vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission cannot be started this way. Unburned fuel
could enter the catalytic converter and once the
engine has started, ignite and damage the converter
and vehicle.
• To prevent damage to the starter, do not continuously crank the engine for more than 15 seconds at
a time. Wait 10 to 15 seconds before trying again.
5
226 STARTING AND OPERATING
After Starting
MANUAL TRANSMISSION — IF EQUIPPED
The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will Five-Speed Manual Transmission
decrease as the engine warms up.
Turbocharger “Cool Down”
This vehicle is equipped with an after-run pump to cool
the turbocharger after the engine is shut off. Depending
on the type of driving and the amount of cargo, the pump
will run for up to 10 minutes after the engine has been
shut off to circulate coolant through the turbocharger.
Although the pump is rubber-mounted for quiet operation, it is normal to hear it running during this time.
WARNING!
You or others could be injured if you leave the
vehicle unattended without having the parking
brake fully applied. The parking brake should always be applied when the driver is not in the vehicle,
especially on an incline.
STARTING AND OPERATING 227
Use each gear in numerical order; do not skip a gear. Be
sure the transmission is in first gear, not third, when
starting from a standing position. Damage to the clutch
can result from starting in third gear.
For most city driving, you will find it easier to use only
the lower gears. For steady highway driving with light
accelerations, fifth gear is recommended.
Never drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal,
and never try to hold the vehicle on a hill with the clutch
pedal partially engaged. This will cause abnormal wear
on the clutch.
Shift Lever
REVERSE gear is not synchronized and the vehicle must
Fully press the clutch pedal before you shift gears. As you be at a complete stop to shift into REVERSE gear. When
release the clutch pedal, lightly press the accelerator selecting REVERSE gear, the driver should pause (appedal.
proximately 2 seconds) after pushing in the clutch pedal
NOTE: To shift into REVERSE from NEUTRAL, lift the and prior to shifting into REVERSE which allows gears to
ring under the knob and, at the same time move the stop spinning. Should an unwanted clash noise be produced, the pause length should be increased.
gearshift lever to the right and then backward.
5
228 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE:
Recommended Shift Speeds
• Clashing REVERSE gear, especially if vehicle is mov- To use your manual transmission for optimal fuel
economy, it should be upshifted as listed in the following
ing, can result in transmission damage.
table.
• During cold weather, until the transmission lubricant
is warm, you may experience slightly higher shift
efforts. This is normal and not harmful to the transmission.
Engine Size
1.4L/1.4L Turbo
Engine
Manual Transmission Recommended Shift Speeds
Units In mph (km/h)
Acceleration
1 to 2
2 to 3
3 to 4
Rate
Accel
14
23
29
(23)
(37)
(47)
Cruise
12
18
25
(19)
(29)
(40)
4 to 5
38
(61)
32
(52)
STARTING AND OPERATING 229
When turning a corner or driving up a steep grade,
Proper downshifting will improve fuel economy and downshift early so that the engine will not be overburdened.
prolong engine life.
Downshifting
CAUTION!
If you skip a gear while downshifting or downshift
at too high of a vehicle speed, these conditions may
cause the engine to overspeed if too low of a gear is
selected and the clutch pedal is released. Damage to
the clutch and the transmission can result from
skipping a gear while downshifting or downshifting
at too high of a vehicle speed even if the clutch pedal
is held pressed (i.e., not released).
To maintain a safe speed and prolong brake life, shift
down to second or first gear when descending a steep
grade.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION — IF EQUIPPED
CAUTION!
Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
• Shift into or out of PARK or REVERSE only after
the vehicle has come to a complete stop.
• Do not shift between PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, or DRIVE when the engine is above idle
speed.
• Before shifting into any gear, make sure your foot
is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
5
230 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: You must press and hold the brake pedal while
shifting out of PARK.
WARNING!
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
Once the key is removed, the transmission is
locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key from the vehicle and lock the vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle
(or in a location accessible to children). A child
could operate power windows, other controls, or
move the vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 231
Key Ignition Park Interlock
Six-Speed Automatic Transmission
This vehicle is equipped with a Key Ignition Park Interlock which requires the transmission to be in PARK
before the ignition switch can be turned to the LOCK/
OFF (key removal) position. The key can only be removed from the ignition when the ignition is in the
LOCK/OFF position, and once removed, the transmission is locked in PARK.
The transmission gear position display (located in the
instrument cluster) indicates the transmission gear range.
You must press the brake pedal to move the shift lever
out of PARK (Refer to “Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System” in this section). To drive, move the shift
lever from PARK or NEUTRAL to the DRIVE position.
The electronically-controlled transmission provides a
precise shift schedule. The transmission electronics are
Brake/Transmission Shift Interlock System
self-calibrating; therefore, the first few shifts on a new
This vehicle is equipped with a Brake Transmission Shift
vehicle may be somewhat abrupt. This is a normal
Interlock System (BTSI) that holds the shift lever in PARK
condition, and precision shifts will develop within a few
unless the brakes are applied. To shift the transmission
hundred miles (kilometers).
out of PARK, the ignition switch must be turned to the
ON/RUN position (engine running or not) and the brake
pedal must be pressed.
5
232 STARTING AND OPERATING
The transmission shift lever has PARK, REVERSE, NEUTRAL, DRIVE, and AutoStick shift positions. Manual
shifts can be made using the AutoStick shift control (refer
to “AutoStick” in this section for further information).
Toggling the shift lever forward (-) or rearward (+) while
in the AutoStick position (beside the DRIVE position)
will manually select the transmission gear, and will
display the current gear in the instrument cluster as 1, 2,
3, etc.
NOTE: If the shift lever cannot be moved to the PARK,
REVERSE, or NEUTRAL position (when pushed forward) it is probably in the AutoStick (+/-) position
Shift Lever
(beside the DRIVE position). In AutoStick mode, the
Only shift from DRIVE to PARK or REVERSE when the
transmission gear (1, 2, 3, etc.) is displayed in the
accelerator pedal is released and the vehicle is stopped.
instrument cluster. Move the shift lever to the right (into
Be sure to keep your foot on the brake pedal when
the DRIVE [D] position) for access to PARK, REVERSE,
shifting between these gears.
and NEUTRAL.
STARTING AND OPERATING 233
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
DO NOT race the engine when shifting from PARK or shifting the transmission to PARK, otherwise the load on the
transmission locking mechanism may make it difficult to
NEUTRAL into another gear range.
move the shift lever out of PARK. As an added precaution,
NOTE: After selecting any gear range, wait a moment to turn the front wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade
allow the selected gear to engage before accelerating. and away from the curb on an uphill grade.
This is especially important when the engine is cold.
Gear Ranges
PARK (P)
This range supplements the parking brake by locking the
transmission. The engine can be started in this range.
Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle is in
motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this range.
When parking on a level surface, you may shift the
transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking
brake.
WARNING!
5
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not completely in PARK. Check by trying to
move the shift lever out of PARK with the brake
pedal released. Make sure the transmission is in
PARK before leaving the vehicle.
(Continued)
234 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If
your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear when
the engine is idling normally and your foot is
firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the
parking brake, shift the transmission into PARK,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
Once the key is removed, the transmission is
locked in PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key from the vehicle and lock the vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle
(or in a location accessible to children). A child
could operate power windows, other controls, or
move the vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 235
CAUTION!
• Before moving the shift lever out of PARK, you
must turn the ignition switch from the LOCK/OFF
position to the ON/RUN position, and also press
the brake pedal. Otherwise, damage to the shift
lever could result.
• DO NOT race the engine when shifting from
PARK or NEUTRAL into another gear range, as this
can damage the drivetrain.
• Look at the transmission gear position display and
verify that it indicates the PARK position.
• With brake pedal released, verify that the shift lever
will not move out of PARK.
REVERSE (R)
This range is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
stop.
NEUTRAL (N)
The following indicators should be used to ensure that
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
you have engaged the transmission into the PARK posiperiods with the engine running. The engine may be
tion:
started in this range. Apply the parking brake and shift
• When shifting into PARK, press the lock button on the the transmission into PARK if you must leave the vehicle.
shift lever and firmly move the lever all the way
forward and to the left until it stops and is fully seated.
5
236 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE (D)
This range should be used for most city and highway
driving. It provides the smoothest upshifts and downshifts, and the best fuel economy. The transmission
automatically upshifts through all forward gears. The
DRIVE position provides optimum driving characteristics under all normal operating conditions.
When frequent transmission shifting occurs (such as
when operating the vehicle under heavy loading conditions, in hilly terrain, or traveling into strong head
winds), use the AutoStick shift control (refer to AutoStick
in this section for further information) to select a lower
gear. Under these conditions, using a lower gear will
improve performance and extend transmission life by
reducing excessive shifting and heat buildup.
If the transmission temperature exceeds normal operating limits, the transmission controller will expand the
STARTING AND OPERATING 237
range of torque converter clutch engagement. This is In the event of a momentary problem, the transmission
done to prevent transmission damage due to overheat- can be reset to regain all forward gears by performing the
following steps:
ing.
During cold temperatures, transmission operation may 1. Stop the vehicle.
be modified depending on engine coolant temperature.
2. Shift the transmission into PARK.
Normal operation will resume once the engine tempera3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position.
ture has risen to a suitable level.
Transmission Limp Home Mode
4. Wait approximately 10 seconds.
Transmission function is monitored electronically for
abnormal conditions. If a condition is detected that could
result in transmission damage, Transmission Limp Home
Mode is activated. In this mode, the transmission remains
in third gear regardless of which forward gear is selected.
PARK, REVERSE, and NEUTRAL will continue to operate. The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may be illuminated. Limp Home Mode allows the vehicle to be
driven to an authorized dealer for service without damaging the transmission.
5. Restart the engine.
6. Shift into the desired gear range. If the problem is no
longer detected, the transmission will return to normal
operation.
NOTE: Even if the transmission can be reset, we recommend that you visit your authorized dealer at your
earliest possible convenience. Your authorized dealer has
diagnostic equipment to determine if the problem could
recur.
5
238 STARTING AND OPERATING
If the transmission cannot be reset, authorized dealer forward (-) triggers a downshift, and rearward (+) an
upshift. The current gear is displayed in the instrument
service is required.
cluster.
AUTOSTICK
NOTE: In AutoStick mode, the transmission will only
AutoStick is a driver-interactive transmission feature shift up or down when the driver moves the shift lever
providing manual shift control, giving you more control rearward (+) or forward (-), except as described below.
of the vehicle. AutoStick allows you to maximize engine
braking, eliminate undesirable upshifts and downshifts, • The transmission will automatically upshift when necessary to prevent engine over-speed.
and improve overall vehicle performance. This system
can also provide you with more control during passing, • The transmission will automatically downshift as the
city driving, cold slippery conditions, mountain driving,
vehicle slows (to prevent engine lugging) and will
and many other situations.
display the current gear.
Operation
When the shift lever is in the AutoStick position (beside
the Drive position), it can be moved forward and rearward. This allows the driver to manually select the
transmission gear being used. Moving the shift lever
• The transmission will automatically downshift to first
gear when coming to a stop. After a stop, the driver
should manually upshift (+) the transmission as the
vehicle is accelerated.
• You can start out (from a stop) in first, second, or third
gear. Starting out in second or third gear can be helpful
STARTING AND OPERATING 239
in snow or icy conditions. To select second or third
gear after the vehicle is brought to a stop, tap the shift
lever rearward (+) once or twice.
• The system will ignore shift commands that would
cause engine lugging or overspeed. An audible beep
will sound if an inappropriate gear is requested.
WARNING!
Do not downshift for additional engine braking on a
slippery surface. The drive wheels could lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid, causing a collision or
personal injury.
• Avoid using speed control when AutoStick is engaged DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
because the transmission will not shift automatically.
Acceleration
• Transmission shifting will be more noticeable when
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slipAutoStick is engaged.
pery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull
• The system may revert to automatic shift mode if a erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs
fault or overheat condition is detected.
when there is a difference in the surface traction under
To disengage AutoStick mode, return the shift lever to the the front (driving) wheels.
DRIVE position. You can shift in or out of the AutoStick
position at any time without taking your foot off the
accelerator pedal.
5
240 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is dangerous.
Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of the
front wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle
and possibly have a collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction
(ice, snow, wet, mud, loose sand, etc.).
1. Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are
slushy.
2. Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles.
3. Replace the tires when tread wear indicators first
become visible.
4. Keep tires properly inflated.
5. Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a
sudden stop.
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
surface. This is hydroplaning and may cause partial or
complete loss of vehicle control and stopping ability. To Driving through water more than a few inches/
reduce this possibility, the following precautions should centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure
safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
be observed:
Traction
STARTING AND OPERATING 241
Flowing/Rising Water
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or path where water
is flowing and/or rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing water can wear away the road or path’s surface
and cause your vehicle to sink into deeper water.
Furthermore, flowing and/or rising water can carry
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in injuries that are serious or
fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
Shallow Standing Water
Although your vehicle is capable of driving through
shallow standing water, consider the following Cautions
and Warnings before doing so.
WARNING!
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s traction capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through standing water.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s braking capabilities, which increases stopping
distances. Therefore, after driving through standing water, drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to dry the brakes.
• Failure to follow these warnings may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
CAUTION!
• Always check the depth of the standing water
before driving through it. Never drive through
(Continued)
5
242 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
standing water that is deeper than the bottom of
the tire rims mounted on the vehicle.
• Determine the condition of the road or the path
that is under water and if there are any obstacles in
the way before driving through the standing water.
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when driving
through standing water. This will minimize wave
effects.
• Driving through standing water may cause damage
to your vehicle’s drivetrain components. Always
inspect your vehicle’s fluids (i.e., engine oil, transmission, axle, etc.) for signs of contamination (i.e.,
fluid that is milky or foamy in appearance) after
driving through standing water. Do not continue to
operate the vehicle if any fluid appears contaminated, as this may result in further damage. Such
damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
• Getting water inside your vehicle’s engine can
cause it to lock up and stall out, and cause serious
internal damage to the engine. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
(Continued)
POWER STEERING
The electric power steering system will give you good
vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability
in tight spaces. The system will vary its assist to provide
light efforts while parking and good feel while driving. If
the electric steering system experiences a fault that
prevents it from providing assist, you will still have the
ability to steer the vehicle manually.
STARTING AND OPERATING 243
WARNING!
Continued operation with reduced or no power steering assist could pose a safety risk to yourself and
others. Service should be obtained as soon as possible.
If the Steering icon, and the ⬙SERVICE POWER STEERING - ASSIST OFF⬙ message is displayed on the EVIC
screen, the vehicle needs to be taken to an authorized
dealer for service. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel”
for further information.
If the Steering icon is flashing, it indicates that the vehicle NOTE:
needs to be taken to an authorized dealer for service. It is • Even if the power steering assistance is no longer
likely the vehicle has lost power steering assistance.
operational, it is still possible to steer the vehicle.
Under these conditions there will be a substantial
If the Steering icon is displayed and the “SERVICE
increase in steering effort, especially at low speeds and
POWER STEERING” message is displayed on the EVIC
during parking maneuvers.
screen, they indicate that extreme steering maneuvers
may have occurred which caused an over temperature • If the condition persists, see your authorized dealer for
condition in the power steering system. Once driving
service.
conditions are safe, pull over and let the vehicle idle for
a few moments until the icon and message turn off. Refer
to “Electronic Vehicle Information (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
5
244 STARTING AND OPERATING
PARKING BRAKE
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking
brake is fully applied. Also, be certain to leave the
manual transmission in REVERSE or first gear.
The parking brake lever is located in the center console.
To apply the parking brake, pull the lever up as firmly as
possible. To release the parking brake, pull the lever up
slightly, press the center button, then lower the lever
completely.
Parking Brake
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch in the MAR (ACC/ON/RUN) position, the Brake
Warning Light in the instrument cluster will illuminate.
STARTING AND OPERATING 245
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front
wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away
from the curb on an uphill grade. The parking brake
should always be applied whenever the driver is not in
the vehicle.
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake
failure and a collision.
• Always fully apply the parking brake when leaving your vehicle, or it may roll and cause damage or
injury. Also be certain to leave a manual transmission in REVERSE or first (1st) gear. Failure to do so
may allow the vehicle to roll and cause damage or
injury.
CAUTION!
If the Brake Warning Light remains on with the
parking brake released, a brake system malfunction
is indicated. Have the brake system serviced by an
authorized dealer immediately.
5
246 STARTING AND OPERATING
SPORT MODE
Manual Transmission — If Equipped
The Sport mode increases steering feedback to the driver
with slight increases in effort and throttle pedal-to-engine
response. This driving mode is useful while driving on
twisty roads where more steering precision is desired in
spirited cornering.
1. To activate the Sport mode, press the SPORT button.
SPORT Button
Once activated, a SPORT message will be displayed in
the instrument cluster.
2. Momentarily release the accelerator pedal.
3. Press the accelerator pedal again to activate.
STARTING AND OPERATING 247
Automatic Transmission — If Equipped
The Sport mode increases steering feedback to the driver
with slight increase in effort and changes the transmission shift schedules for more aggressive shifting. This
driving mode is useful while driving on twisty roads
where more steering precision is desired in spirited
cornering.
5
1. To activate the Sport mode, press the SPORT button.
SPORT Button
Once activated, a SPORT message will be displayed in
the instrument cluster.
2. Press the SPORT button again to return to the standard
driving mode.
248 STARTING AND OPERATING
BRAKE SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with dual hydraulic brake
systems. If either of the two hydraulic systems loses
normal capability, the remaining system will still function. However, there will be some loss of overall braking
effectiveness. You may notice increased pedal travel
during application, greater pedal force required to slow
or stop, and potential activation of the “Brake System
Warning Light”.
Your vehicle is equipped with a advanced electronic
brake control system that includes the Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS), Brake Assist System (BAS), Traction Control System (TCS), Hill Start Assist (HSA), and Electronic
Stability Control (ESC). All systems work together to
enhance vehicle stability and control in various driving
conditions and are commonly referred to as ESC.
In the event power assist is lost for any reason (i.e.,
repeated brake applications with the engine off) the
brakes will still function. However, the effort required to
brake the vehicle will be much greater than that required
with the power system operating.
The Four-Wheel ABS is designed to aid the driver in
maintaining vehicle control under adverse braking conditions. The system operates with a separate computer to
modulate hydraulic pressure, to prevent wheel lock-up
and to help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.
Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
The system’s pump motor runs during an ABS stop to
provide regulated hydraulic pressure. The pump motor
makes a low humming noise during operation, which is
normal.
STARTING AND OPERATING 249
The ABS includes an amber ABS Warning Light. When
the light is illuminated, the ABS is not functioning. The
system reverts to standard non-anti-lock brakes. Turning
the ignition Off and On again may reset the ABS if the
fault detected was only momentary.
WARNING!
• Pumping the Anti-Lock Brakes will diminish their
effectiveness and may lead to a collision. Pumping
makes the stopping distance longer. Just press
firmly on your brake pedal when you need to slow
down or stop.
• The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) cannot prevent
the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle, nor can it increase braking or steering
efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of
the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• The ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
• The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner, which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
When you are in a severe braking condition involving the
use of the ABS, you will experience some pedal drop as
the vehicle comes to a stop. This is the result of the
system reverting to the base brake system.
Engagement of the ABS may be accompanied by a
pulsing sensation. You may also hear a clicking noise.
These occurrences are normal and indicate that the
system is functioning properly.
5
250 STARTING AND OPERATING
Brake Assist System (BAS)
The BAS is designed to optimize the vehicle’s braking
capability during emergency braking maneuvers. The
system detects an emergency braking situation by sensing the rate and amount of brake application and then
applies optimum pressure to the brakes. This can help
reduce braking distances. The BAS complements the
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS). Applying the brakes very
quickly results in the best BAS assistance. To receive the
benefit of the system, you must apply continuous braking pressure during the stopping sequence (do not
“pump” the brakes). Do not reduce brake pedal pressure
unless braking is no longer desired. Once the brake pedal
is released, the BAS is deactivated.
WARNING!
• The Brake Assist System (BAS) cannot prevent the
natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle,
nor can it increase the traction afforded by prevailing road conditions.
• The BAS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, driving on
very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning.
• The capabilities of a BAS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
STARTING AND OPERATING 251
Traction Control System (TCS)
This system monitors the amount of wheel spin of each of
the driven wheels. If wheel spin is detected, brake
pressure is applied to the slipping wheel(s) and engine
power is reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and
stability. A feature of the TCS system, Brake Limited
Differential (BLD), functions similar to a limited slip
differential and controls the wheel spin across a driven
axle. If one wheel on a driven axle is spinning faster than
the other, the system will apply the brake of the spinning
wheel. This will allow more engine torque to be applied
to the wheel that is not spinning. This feature remains
active even if TCS and ESC are in the Partial Off mode.
Refer to “Electronic Stability Control (ESC)” in this
section for further information.
Hill Start Assist (HSA)
The HSA system is designed to assist the driver when
starting a vehicle from a stop on a hill. HSA will maintain
the level of brake pressure the driver applied for a short
period of time after the driver takes his foot off the brake
pedal. If the driver does not apply the throttle during this
short period of time, the system will release brake
pressure and the vehicle will roll down the hill. The
system will release brake pressure in proportion to the
amount of throttle applied as the vehicle starts to move in
the intended direction of travel.
HSA Activation Criteria
The following criteria must be met in order for HSA to
activate:
• Vehicle must be stopped.
• Vehicle must be on a 2.5% (manual transmission) or 7%
grade or greater (automatic transmission) hill.
• Gear selection matches vehicle uphill direction (i.e.,
vehicle in NEUTRAL (manual transmission), vehicle
5
252 STARTING AND OPERATING
facing uphill is in forward gear; vehicle backing uphill Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
is in REVERSE gear).
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system enhances
directional control and stability of the vehicle under
WARNING!
various driving conditions. ESC corrects for oversteering
There may be situations on minor hills with a loaded or understeering of the vehicle by applying the brake of
vehicle, or while pulling a trailer, when the system the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting the
will not activate and slight rolling may occur. This oversteering or understeering condition. Engine power
could cause a collision with another vehicle or object. may also be reduced to help the vehicle maintain the
Always remember the driver is responsible for brak- desired path. ESC uses sensors in the vehicle to determine the vehicle path intended by the driver and coming the vehicle.
pares it to the actual path of the vehicle. When the actual
path does not match the intended path, ESC applies the
Disabling/Enabling HSA
brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in counteracting
If you wish to turn the HSA system on or off, it can be
the oversteer or understeer condition.
done using the Customer Programmable Features in the
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC). Refer to • Oversteer - when the vehicle is turning more than
“Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Unappropriate for the steering wheel position.
derstanding Your Instrument Panel” for further informa• Understeer - when the vehicle is turning less than
tion.
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
STARTING AND OPERATING 253
5
ESC Off Switch (Automatic Transmission)
ESC Off Switch (Manual Transmission)
NOTE: The ESC Off switch is located left of the steering
column (Manual Transmission Only).
254 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle, nor can it increase the traction afforded by
prevailing road conditions. ESC cannot prevent all
accidents, including those resulting from excessive
speed in turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or
hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent collisions
resulting from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Only a safe,
attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents.
The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner
which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety
of others.
ESC Operating Modes
The ESC system has two available operating modes.
Full On
This is the normal operating mode for ESC. Whenever
the vehicle is started, the ESC system will be in On mode.
This mode should be used for most driving situations.
ESC should only be turned to Partial Off for specific
reasons as noted below.
Partial Off
This mode is entered by momentarily pushing the ESC
Off switch. This mode is intended to be used if the vehicle
is in deep snow, sand or gravel conditions and more
wheel spin than ESC would normally allow is required to
gain traction.
STARTING AND OPERATING 255
To turn ESC on again, momentarily pushing the switch
again. This will restore the normal ESC On mode of
operation.
WARNING! (Continued)
reduction feature of TCS is disabled, and the
enhanced vehicle stability offered by the ESC system is reduced.
NOTE: To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving
with snow chains, or starting off in deep snow, sand or
gravel, it may be desirable to switch to the Partial Off ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
mode by pushing the switch. Once the situation requiring ESC OFF Indicator Light
ESC to be switched to the Partial Off mode is overcome,
turn ESC back on by momentarily pushing the switch.
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
This may be done while the vehicle is in motion.
Light in the instrument cluster will come on
when the ignition switch is turned to the MAR
WARNING!
(ACC/ON/RUN) position for four seconds. If
the
ESC
Activation/Malfunction
Indicator Light comes
• When in “Partial Off” mode, the TCS functionality
on
continuously
with
the
engine
running,
a malfunction
of ESC, (except for the limited slip feature dehas
been
detected
in
the
ESC
system.
If
this
light remains
scribed in the TCS section), has been disabled and
on
after
several
ignition
cycles,
and
the
vehicle
has been
the “ESC Off Indicator Light” will be illuminated.
driven
several
miles
(kilometers)
at
speeds
greater
than
When in “Partial Off” mode, the engine power
(Continued)
5
256 STARTING AND OPERATING
30 mph (48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon as NOTE:
possible to have the problem diagnosed and corrected.
• The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light and
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light (located
the ESC OFF Indicator Light come on momentarily
in the instrument cluster) starts to flash as soon as the
each time the ignition switch is turned ON.
tires lose traction and the ESC system becomes active.
• Each time the ignition is turned ON, the ESC system
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light also
will be ON even if it was turned off previously.
flashes when TCS is active. If the ESC Activation/
Malfunction Indicator Light begins to flash during accelThe ESC OFF Indicator Light indicates the
eration, ease up on the accelerator and apply as little
throttle as possible. Be sure to adapt your speed and
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is partially
driving to the prevailing road conditions.
off.
STARTING AND OPERATING 257
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
NOTE:
Tire Markings
• P (Passenger) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P”
molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
• European — Metric tire sizing is based on European
design standards. Tires designed to this standard have
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with
the section width. The letter ⬙P⬙ is absent from this tire
size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
1 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards
Code (TIN)
2 — Size Designation
3 — Service Description
4 — Maximum Load
5 — Maximum Pressure
6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
• LT (Light Truck) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
5
258 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Temporary spare tires are designed for temporary • High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design
emergency use only. Temporary high pressure comstandards and it begins with the tire diameter molded
pact spare tires have the letter “T” or “S” molded into
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example:
T145/80D18 103M.
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE:
Example Size Designation: P215/65R15XL 95H, 215/65R15 96H, LT235/85R16C, T145/80D18 103M, 31x10.5 R15 LT
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards, or
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards, or
LT = Light truck tire based on U.S. design standards, or
T or S = Temporary spare tire or
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215, 235, 145 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65, 85, 80 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
– Ratio of section height to section width of tire, or
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
STARTING AND OPERATING 259
EXAMPLE:
R = Construction code
– ⬙R⬙ means radial construction, or
– ⬙D⬙ means diagonal or bias construction
15, 16, 18 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
– A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
– A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to
its load index under certain operating conditions
– The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under
specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and
posted speed limits)
5
260 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
Load Identification:
Absence of the following load identification symbols on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL)
tire:
• XL = Extra load (or reinforced) tire, or
• LL = Light load tire or
• C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load – Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure – Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this
tire
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire, tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on
however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires the outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard
side of the tire.
with white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the
date code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire.
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
STARTING AND OPERATING 261
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
– This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 03 means the 3rd week
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 01 means the year 2001
– Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the year
in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991
5
262 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Terminology And Definitions
Term
B-Pillar
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation
Pressure
Tire Placard
Definition
The vehicle B-Pillar is the structural member of the body located
behind the front door.
Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after
the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven
less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three
hours. Inflation pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per
square inch) or kPa (kilopascals).
The maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible
cold tire inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation
pressure is molded into the sidewall.
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold tire inflation pressure
as shown on the tire placard.
A label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the vehicle’s loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and the
recommended cold tire inflation pressures.
STARTING AND OPERATING 263
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
Tire And Loading Information Placard Location
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on
the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver’s
side door.
5
Example Tire Placard Location (B-Pillar)
Example Tire Placard Location (Door)
264 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire And Loading Information Placard
This placard tells you important information about the:
1. Number of people that can be carried in the vehicle.
2. Total weight your vehicle can carry.
3. Tire size designed for your vehicle.
4. Cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and
spare tires.
Loading
Tire And Loading Information Placard
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You
will not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if you
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading
Information placard and in the “Vehicle Loading” section
of this manual.
STARTING AND OPERATING 265
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition, Steps For Determining Correct Load Limit
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occuaxles must not be exceeded. For further information on
pants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to
XXX kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
“Vehicle Loading” in this manual.
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or 3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
XXX kg” on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed
the weight referenced here.
5
266 STARTING AND OPERATING
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of NOTE:
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
• If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your
“XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. The followbe five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the
ing table shows examples on how to calculate total
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity
load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities of your
is 650 lbs (295 kg) (since 5 x 150 lbs (68 kg) = 750 lbs
vehicle with varying seating configurations and num(340 kg), and 1400 lbs (635 kg) – 750 lbs (340 kg) =
ber and size of occupants. This table is for illustration
650 lbs [295 kg]).
purposes only and may not be accurate for the seating
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo
and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not
• For the following example, the combined weight of
safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load
occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs
capacity calculated in step 4.
(392 kg).
STARTING AND OPERATING 267
5
268 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading
can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and
increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never
overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Four primary areas
are affected by improper tire pressure:
• Safety and Vehicle Stability
• Economy
• Tread Wear
• Ride Comfort
Safety
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can
cause collisions.
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing and can result in overheating and tire failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushion
shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can
cause damage that result in tire failure.
• Overinflated or under-inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in
loss of vehicle control.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 269
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the
right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
Fuel Economy
Underinflated tires will increase tire rolling resistance
resulting in higher fuel consumption.
Tread Wear
Improper cold tire inflation pressures can cause abnormal wear patterns and reduced tread life, resulting in the
need for earlier tire replacement.
Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
Both under-inflation and over-inflation affect the stability
of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of sluggish Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.
Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable
response or over responsiveness in the steering.
ride.
NOTE:
Tire Inflation Pressures
• Unequal tire pressures from side to side may cause
The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the
erratic and unpredictable steering response.
driver’s side B-Pillar or rear edge of the driver’s side
• Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the door.
vehicle to drift left or right.
5
270 STARTING AND OPERATING
At least once a month:
1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three hours.
The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the
• Check and adjust tire pressure with a good quality
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidepocket-type pressure gauge. Do not make a visual
wall.
judgement when determining proper inflation. Tires
may look properly inflated even when they are under- Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with
inflated.
temperature changes.
• Inspect tires for signs of tire wear or visible damage.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per
12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind
CAUTION!
when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, althe Winter.
ways reinstall the valve stem cap. This will prevent
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) and the
moisture and dirt from entering the valve stem,
outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then the cold tire
which could damage the valve stem.
inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
“cold tire inflation pressure”. Cold tire inflation pressure outside temperature condition.
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not
been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than
STARTING AND OPERATING 271
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)
during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
WARNING!
High speed driving with your vehicle under maximum load is dangerous. The added strain on your
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a
serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle loaded to the
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above
75 mph (120 km/h).
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds and
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle Radial Ply Tires
loading may be required for high-speed vehicle operation. Refer to your authorized tire dealer or original
WARNING!
equipment vehicle dealer for recommended safe operatCombining radial ply tires with other types of tires
ing speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
poorly. The instability could cause a collision. Always use radial ply tires in sets of four. Never
combine them with other types of tires.
5
272 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Repair
Tire Types
If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if it All Season Tires — If Equipped
meets the following criteria:
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (Spring,
Summer, Fall and Winter). Traction levels may vary
• The tire has not been driven on when flat.
between different all season tires. All season tires can be
• The damage is only on the tread section of your tire
identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on
(sidewall damage is not repairable).
the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four;
• The puncture is no greater than a ¼ of an inch (6 mm). failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs and
additional information.
Summer Or Three Season Tires — If Equipped
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have
experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced immediately with another Run Flat tire of identical size and
service description (Load Index and Speed Symbol).
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry
conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or
on ice. If your vehicle is equipped with Summer tires, be
aware these tires are not designed for Winter or cold
driving conditions. Install Winter tires on your vehicle
when ambient temperatures are less than 40°F (5°C) or if
roads are covered with ice or snow. For more information, contact an authorized dealer.
STARTING AND OPERATING 273
Summer tires do not contain the all season designation or
mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall. Use
Summer tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may
adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
WARNING!
Do not use Summer tires in snow/ice conditions. You
could lose vehicle control, resulting in severe injury
or death. Driving too fast for conditions also creates
the possibility of loss of vehicle control.
Snow Tires
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires
during the Winter. Snow tires can be identified by a
“mountain/snowflake” symbol on the tire sidewall.
If you need snow tires, select tires
equivalent in size and type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires
only in sets of four; failure to do so
may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph
(120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to
original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for
recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold
tire inflation pressures.
5
274 STARTING AND OPERATING
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid
and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states prohibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be
checked before using these tire types.
Run Flat Tires — If Equipped
Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive 50 miles
(80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a rapid loss of inflation
pressure. This rapid loss of inflation is referred to as the
Run Flat mode. A Run Flat mode occurs when the tire
inflation pressure is of/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a
Run Flat tire reaches the run flat mode it has limited
driving capabilities and needs to be replaced immediately. A Run Flat tire is not repairable.
See the tire pressure monitoring section for more information.
Spare Tires — If Equipped
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Tire Service Kit
instead of a spare tire, please refer to “Tire Service Kit” in
“What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
CAUTION!
Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take
your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a
compact or limited-use temporary spare installed.
Damage to the vehicle may result.
Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
It is not recommended driving a vehicle loaded at full Wheel — If Equipped
capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the run flat
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and
mode.
wheel equivalent in look and function to the original
STARTING AND OPERATING 275
equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle
of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire
rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option,
refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended
tire rotation pattern.
Since this tire has limited tread life, the original equipment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled
on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire.
Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only. Do not install more than one compact spare tire and
You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
compact spare by looking at the spare tire description on
WARNING!
the Tire and Loading Information Placard located on the
driver’s side door opening or on the sidewall of the tire. Compact spares are for temporary emergency use
Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the letter “T” only. With these spares, do not drive more than
or “S” preceding the size designation. Example: T145/ 50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary use spares have limited
80D18 103M.
tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear
indicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to be
T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
replaced. Be sure to follow the warnings, which
apply to your spare. Failure to do so could result in
spare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.
5
276 STARTING AND OPERATING
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only.
first opportunity.
This tire may look like the originally equipped tire on the
front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare
WARNING!
tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn
to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size Limited-use spares are for emergency use only. Inspare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
stallation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the handling. With this tire, do not drive more than the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the speed listed on the limit-use spare wheel. Keep
first opportunity.
inflated to the cold tire inflation pressures listed on
Full Size Spare — If Equipped
Limited-Use Spare — If Equipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency
use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the
limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving
limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the
original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your
vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare
tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as
your Tire and Loading Information Placard located
on the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the
driver’s side door. Replace (or repair) the original
equipment tire at the first opportunity and reinstall it
on your vehicle. Failure to do so could result in loss
of vehicle control.
STARTING AND OPERATING 277
Tire Spinning
Tread Wear Indicators
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires
spin your vehicle’s wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or to help you in determining when your tires should be
for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stop- replaced.
ping.
Refer to “Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
5
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire damage or failure. A tire could explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than
30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
1 — Worn Tire
2 — New Tire
278 STARTING AND OPERATING
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread • Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or
higher, and Summer tires typically have a reduced
grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth
tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle mainbecomes a 1/16 of an inch (2 mm). When the tread is
tenance schedule is highly recommended.
worn to the tread wear indicators, the tire should be
replaced. Refer to “Replacement Tires” in this section for
further information.
WARNING!
Life Of Tire
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
factors including, but not limited to:
• Driving style.
• Tire pressure - Improper cold tire inflation pressures
can cause uneven wear patterns to develop across the
tire tread. These abnormal wear patterns will reduce
tread life, resulting in the need for earlier tire replacement.
• Distance driven.
Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after six
years, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to
follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure.
You could lose control and have a collision resulting
in serious injury or death.
Keep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little
exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact
with oil, grease, and gasoline.
Replacement Tires
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for
STARTING AND OPERATING 279
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressures. The manufacturer strongly recommends that you use tires equivalent to the originals in size, quality and performance
when replacement is needed. Refer to the paragraph on
“Tread Wear Indicator”. Refer to the Tire and Loading
Information placard or the Vehicle Certification Label for
the size designation of your tire. The Load Index and
Speed Symbol for your tire will be found on the original
equipment tire sidewall. See the Tire Sizing Chart example found in the Tire Safety Information section of this
manual for more information relating to the Load Index
and Speed Symbol of a tire.
It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two
rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously
affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a
wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match
those of the original wheels.
It is recommended you contact your authorized tire
dealer or original equipment dealer with any questions
you may have on tire specifications or capability. Failure
to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect
the safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
WARNING!
• Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than
that specified for your vehicle. Some combinations
of unapproved tires and wheels may change suspension dimensions and performance characteristics, resulting in changes to steering, handling, and
braking of your vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handling and stress to steering and suspension components. You could lose control and have
a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use
only the tire and wheel sizes with load ratings
approved for your vehicle.
(Continued)
5
280 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or
capacity, other than what was originally equipped
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load
index could result in tire overloading and failure.
You could lose control and have a collision.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having
adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
CAUTION!
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size
may result in false speedometer and odometer readings.
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
Use of traction devices require sufficient tire-to-body
clearance. Follow these recommendations to guard
against damage:
• Traction device must be of proper size for the tire, as
recommended by the traction device manufacturer.
• Install on Front Tires.
• Due to limited clearance, a 185/55R15 tire with a
Security Chain Company (SCC) Super Z6 low profile
traction device or equivalent is recommended.
WARNING!
Using tires of different size and type (M+S, Snow)
between front and rear axles can cause unpredictable
handling. You could lose control and have a collision.
STARTING AND OPERATING 281
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
To avoid damage to your vehicle or tires, observe the
following precautions:
• Because of restricted traction device clearance between tires and other suspension components, it is
important that only traction devices in good condition are used. Broken devices can cause serious
damage. Stop the vehicle immediately if noise
occurs that could indicate device breakage. Remove
the damaged parts of the device before further use.
• Install device as tightly as possible and then retighten after driving about ½ mile (0.8 km).
• Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Drive cautiously and avoid severe turns and large
bumps, especially with a loaded vehicle.
• Do not drive for a prolonged period on dry pavement.
(Continued)
• Observe the traction device manufacturer’s instructions on the method of installation, operating
speed, and conditions for use. Always use the
suggested operating speed of the device manufacturer’s if it is less than 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Do not use traction devices on a compact spare tire.
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
The tires on the front and rear of your vehicle operate at
different loads and perform different steering, driving,
and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at
unequal rates.
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires.
The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with
aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type
5
282 STARTING AND OPERATING
tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain
mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute to a
smooth, quiet ride.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals. The reasons for any rapid or
unusual wear should be corrected prior to rotation being
performed.
The suggested rotation method is the “rearward cross”
shown in the following diagram. This rotation pattern
does not apply to some directional tires that must not be
reversed.
Tire Rotation
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the
driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recommended cold tire pressure.
STARTING AND OPERATING 283
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1
psi (7 kPa) for every 12° F (6.5° C). This means that when
the outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will
decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on
cold inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire
pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least
three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a
three hour period. The cold tire inflation pressure must
not exceed the maximum inflation pressure molded into
the tire sidewall. Refer to “Tires – General Information”
in “Starting And Operating” for information on how to
properly inflate the vehicle’s tires. The tire pressure will
also increase as the vehicle is driven, this is normal and
there should be no adjustment for this increased pressure.
The TPMS will continue to warn the driver of low tire
pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not turn
off until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended
cold tire pressure on the placard. Once the low tire
pressure warning (Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light) illuminates, you must increase the tire pressure to
the recommended cold tire pressure in order for the Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light to turn off. The system
will automatically update and the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn off once the system receives
the updated tire pressures. The vehicle may need to be
driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in
order for the TPMS to receive this information.
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended
cold (parked for more than three hours) tire pressure of
The TPMS will warn the driver of a low tire pressure if 30 psi (207 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68° F
the tire pressure falls below the low pressure warning (20° C) and the measured tire pressure is 27 psi (186 kPa),
limit for any reason, including low temperature effects, or a temperature drop to 20° F (-7° C) will decrease the tire
pressure to approximately 23 psi (159 kPa). This tire
natural pressure loss through the tire.
5
284 STARTING AND OPERATING
pressure is sufficiently low enough to turn on the Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light. Driving the vehicle
may cause the tire pressure to rise to approximately 27
psi (186 kPa), but the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light will still be on. In this situation, the Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light will turn off only after the tires
are inflated to the vehicle’s recommended cold tire pressure value.
CAUTION!
• The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warnings have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using
replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
(Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
sensor to become inoperable. After using an aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended that you take
your vehicle to your an authorized dealership to
have your sensor function checked.
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure,
always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will
prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve
stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensor.
NOTE:
• The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care
and maintenance, or to provide warning of a tire
failure or condition.
STARTING AND OPERATING 285
• The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge Base System
while adjusting your tire pressure.
This is the TPMS warning indicator located in the
• Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes
instrument cluster.
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire The TPMS uses wireless technology with wheel rim
tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and mounted electronic sensors to monitor tire pressure levstopping ability.
els. Sensors, mounted to each wheel as part of the valve
• The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire mainte- stem, transmit tire pressure readings to the Receiver
nance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain Module.
correct tire pressure using an accurate tire gauge, even NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the
if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger tire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle regularly
illumination of the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale and to maintain the proper pressure.
Light.
The TPMS consists of the following components:
• Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure,
and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in • Receiver Module.
the tire.
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors.
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light.
5
286 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
the “Service Tire Pressure Monitoring System” text message will display. If the ignition key is cycled, this
sequence will repeat providing the system fault still
exists. The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will
turn off when the fault condition no longer exists. A
system fault can occur with any of the following scenarios:
The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will illuminate in the instrument cluster, an audible chime will be
activated, and the “Check left or right front/rear tire
xxx.x psi” text message will display when one or more of
the four active road tire pressures are low. Should this
occur, you should stop as soon as possible, check the
inflation pressure of each tire on your vehicle, and inflate • Jamming due to electronic devices or driving next to
each tire to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard
facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as the
pressure value. The system will automatically update
TPM sensors.
and the Tire Pressure Monitoring Light will extinguish
• Installing some form of aftermarket window tinting
once the updated tire pressures have been received. The
that affects radio wave signals.
vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h) to receive this information.
• Snow or ice around the wheels or wheel housings.
Check TPMS Warnings
• Using tire chains on the vehicle.
The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will flash on • Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
and off for 75 seconds and remain on solid when a system
fault is detected, an audible chime will be activated and
STARTING AND OPERATING 287
NOTE: Your vehicle may be equipped with a compact • This occurs for each subsequent ignition key cycle, a
spare wheel and tire assembly.
chime will sound and the Tire Pressure Monitoring
Telltale Light will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
• The compact spare tire does not have a tire pressure
then remain on solid.
monitoring sensor. Therefore, the TPMS will not monitor the tire pressure in the compact spare tire.
• Once you repair or replace the original road tire and
reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare
• If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
tire, the TPMS will update automatically and the Tire
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warnPressure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn OFF, as
ing limit, upon the next ignition key cycle, a chime will
long as no tire pressure is below the low-pressure
sound and the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
warning limit in any of the four active road tires. The
will still turn ON due to the low tire.
vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes
• However, after driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes
above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to
receive this information.
above 15 mph (24 km/h), the Tire Pressure Monitoring
Telltale Light will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
then remain on solid.
5
288 STARTING AND OPERATING
Enhanced System — If Equipped
The TPMS consists of the following components:
When the vehicle is equipped with an enhanced TPM • Receiver module
system, the driver can view text messages showing the
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors
actual tire pressure value by position by selecting the tire
pressure menu command in the instrument cluster. Refer • Various Tire Pressure Monitoring System messages,
to the instrument panel features section of the owners
which display in the Electronic Vehicle Information
manual.
Center (EVIC)
Premium TPM System
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each
illuminate in the instrument cluster and a chime will
wheel as part of the valve stem, transmit tire pressure
sound when tire pressure is low in one or more of the
readings to the receiver module.
four active road tires. In addition, the Electronic
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display a
graphic showing the pressure values of each tire with
the low tire pressure tire highlighted in a different
color.
STARTING AND OPERATING 289
to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this information.
TPMS Warning
Low Tire Indicator
Should this occur, you should stop as soon as possible
and inflate the tires with low pressure to the vehicle’s
recommended cold placard pressure value. Once the
system receives the updated tire pressures, the system
will automatically update and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off. The vehicle may need
When a system fault is detected, the “Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75
seconds and then remain on solid. The system fault will
sound a chime and also display a “Service Tire Pressure
Monitoring System” message in the EVIC for approximately 5 seconds and then display dashes (- -) in place of
the pressure value to indicate which sensor is not being
received.
5
290 STARTING AND OPERATING
A system fault can occur due to any of the following:
1. Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving
next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as
the TPM sensors.
2. Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains
materials that may block radio wave signals.
3. Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or
wheel housings.
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
Service TPM System Message
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
If the ignition switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat,
providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault
no longer exists, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light” will no longer flash, and the “Service Tire Pressure
Monitoring System” message will no longer display, and
a pressure value will display in place of the dashes.
The EVIC will also display a ⬙Service Tire Pressure
Monitoring System⬙ message for a minimum of five
seconds when a system fault related to an incorrect
sensor location fault is detected. In this case, the ⬙Service
Tire Pressure Monitoring System⬙ message is then followed with a graphic display with pressure values still
STARTING AND OPERATING 291
shown. This indicates that the pressure values are still
being received from the TPM sensors but they may not be
located in the correct vehicle position. The system still
needs to be serviced as long as the ⬙Service Tire Pressure
Monitoring System⬙ message is displayed.
Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
then remain on solid. In addition, the EVIC will
display a “Service TPM System” message and then
display dashes (- -) in place of the pressure value.
• For each subsequent ignition switch cycle, a chime will
sound, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light”
will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on
• The TPMS will not monitor the pressure in a replacesolid, and the EVIC will display a “Service Tire Presment tire installed without a tire pressure sensor.
sure Monitoring System” message and dashes (- -) in
place of the pressure value.
• If you install a replacement tire in place of a road tire
that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning
Once you repair or replace the original road tire and
limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, the “Tire
reinstall it, the TPMS will update automatically. In addiPressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will remain on and tion, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
a chime will sound. In addition, the graphic in the turn off and the graphic in the EVIC will display a new
EVIC will still display a pressure value highlighted in pressure value instead of dashes (- -), as long as no tire
a different color.
pressure is below the low-pressure warning limit in any
• After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above of the four active road tires. The vehicle may need to be
15 mph (24 km/h), the “Tire Pressure Monitoring driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in
order for the TPMS to receive this information.
NOTE:
5
292 STARTING AND OPERATING
General Information
FUEL REQUIREMENTS — 1.4L Engine
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
This engine is designed to meet all emissions regulations and provide optimum
fuel economy and performance when us• This device may not cause harmful interference.
ing high quality unleaded “Regular” gaso• This device must accept any interference received,
line having a posted octane number of 87
including interference that may cause undesired op- as specified by the (R+M)/2 method. The use of higher
eration.
octane “Premium” gasoline is not required, as it will not
The tire pressure sensors are covered under one of the provide any benefit over “Regular” gasoline in these
engines.
following licenses:
United States
Canada
MRXC4W4MA4
2546A-C4W4MA4
(Single)
While operating on gasoline with an octane number of
87, hearing a light knocking sound from the engine is not
a cause for concern. However, if the engine is heard
making a heavy knocking sound, see your dealer immediately. Use of gasoline with an octane number lower
than 87 can cause engine failure and may void or not be
covered by the New Vehicle Warranty.
STARTING AND OPERATING 293
Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard
starting, stalling and hesitations. If you experience these
symptoms, try another brand of gasoline before considering service for the vehicle.
making a heavy knocking sound, see your dealer immediately. Use of gasoline with an octane number lower
than 87 can cause engine failure and may void or not be
covered by the New Vehicle Warranty.
Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard
starting, stalling, and hesitations. If you experience these
symptoms, try another brand of gasoline before considThis engine is designed to meet all emis- ering service for the vehicle.
sion regulations, provide satisfactory fuel
economy and performance when using Reformulated Gasoline
high-quality unleaded “Regular” gasoline Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner
having a posted octane number of 87 as burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline”.
specified by the (R+M)/2 method. For optimum perfor- Reformulated gasoline contain oxygenates and are spemance and fuel economy the use of “Premium” 91 octane cifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and imgasoline or higher is recommended.
prove air quality.
FUEL REQUIREMENTS — 1.4L Turbo
While operating on gasoline with an octane number of The use of reformulated gasoline is recommended. Prop87, hearing a light knocking sound from the engine is not erly blended reformulated gasoline will provide ima cause for concern. However, if the engine is heard proved performance and durability of engine and fuel
system components.
5
294 STARTING AND OPERATING
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
E-85 Usage In Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxygenates such as 10% Ethanol, Methyl Tert-Butyl Ether
(MTBE), and Ethyl Tret-Butyl Ether (ETBE). Oxygenates
are required in some areas of the country during the
winter months to reduce carbon monoxide emissions.
Fuels blended with these oxygenates may be used in
your vehicle.
Non-Flex Fuel Vehicles (FFV) are compatible with gasoline containing up to 10% ethanol (E10). Gasoline with
higher ethanol content may void the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
CAUTION!
Do not use gasoline containing Methanol or E-85
Ethanol. Use of these blends may result in starting
and drivability problems and may damage critical
fuel system components.
If a Non-FFV vehicle is inadvertently fueled with E-85
fuel, the engine will have some or all of these symptoms:
• Operate in a lean mode.
• OBD II “Malfunction Indicator Light” on.
• Poor engine performance.
• Poor cold start and cold drivability.
• Increased risk for fuel system component corrosion.
Problems that result from using methanol/gasoline MMT In Gasoline
blends are not the responsibility of the manufacturer.
Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl (MMT)
While MTBE is an oxygenate made from Methanol, it
is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is
does not have the negative effects of Methanol.
STARTING AND OPERATING 295
blended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasoline Fuel System Cautions
blended with MMT provides no performance advantage
beyond gasoline of the same octane number without
CAUTION!
MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduces spark plug
life and reduces emissions system performance in some Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle’s
vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that gasoline performance:
without MMT be used in your vehicle. The MMT content • The use of leaded gasoline is prohibited by Federal
law. Using leaded gasoline can impair engine perof gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump,
formance and damage the emissions control systherefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether
tem.
the gasoline contains MMT. MMT is prohibited in Federal
•
An out-of-tune engine or certain fuel or ignition
and California reformulated gasoline.
malfunctions can cause the catalytic converter to
Materials Added To Fuel
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or
some light smoke, your engine may be out of tune
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to
or malfunctioning and may require immediate sercontain effective detergent additives. Use of additional
vice. Contact your authorized dealer for service
detergents or other additives is not needed under normal
assistance.
conditions and they would result in additional cost.
Therefore, you should not have to add anything to the
(Continued)
fuel.
5
296 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
• The use of fuel additives, which are now being
sold as octane enhancers, is not recommended.
Most of these products contain high concentrations
of methanol. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such
fuels or additives is not the responsibility of the
manufacturer and may void or not be covered
under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with the emissions control
system can result in civil penalties being assessed against
you.
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.
Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon
monoxide poisoning:
• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbon
monoxide, a colorless and odorless gas, which can
kill. Never run the engine in a closed area, such as
a garage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running for an extended period. If the
vehicle is stopped in an open area with the engine
running for more than a short period, adjust the
ventilation system to force fresh, outside air into
the vehicle.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 297
WARNING! (Continued)
• Guard against carbon monoxide with proper maintenance. Have the exhaust system inspected every
time the vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal
conditions repaired promptly. Until repaired, drive
with all side windows fully open.
5
ADDING FUEL
Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap)
The gas cap is located on the passenger side of the
vehicle. If the gas cap is lost or damaged, be sure the
replacement cap is the correct one for this vehicle.
Fuel Filler Cap
CAUTION!
• Damage to the fuel system or emission control
system could result from using an improper fuel
filler cap. A poorly fitting cap could let impurities
(Continued)
298 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
into the fuel system. Also, a poorly fitting aftermarket cap can cause the “Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL)” to illuminate, due to fuel vapors escaping
from the system.
• To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “top
off” the fuel tank after filling.
• A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into a
portable container that is inside of a vehicle. You
could be burned. Always place gas containers on
the ground while filling.
WARNING!
• Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the
vehicle when the gas cap is removed or the tank is
being filled.
• Never add fuel when the engine is running. It may
cause the MIL to turn on and could cause a fire.
NOTE:
• When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, the fuel tank
is full.
• Tighten the gas cap about 1/4 turn until you hear one
click. This is an indication that the cap is properly
tightened.
• If the gas cap is not tightened properly, the MIL will
come on. Be sure the gas cap is tightened every time
the vehicle is refueled.
STARTING AND OPERATING 299
turn the message off. If the problem persists, the message
will appear the next time the vehicle is started. This
After fuel has been added, the vehicle diagnostic system might indicate a damaged cap. If the problem is detected
can determine if the fuel filler cap is possibly loose, twice in a row, the system will turn on the MIL. Resolving
improperly installed, or damaged. If the system detects a
the problem will turn the MIL off.
malfunction, the “gASCAP” message will display in the
odometer display. Tighten the gas cap until a ⬙clicking⬙ TRAILER TOWING
sound is heard. This is an indication that the gas cap is
properly tightened. Press the odometer reset button to Trailer towing with this vehicle is not recommended.
Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Wheels OFF the Ground
NONE
Dolly Tow
Front
Rear
ALL
On Trailer
Manual Transmission
Transmission in
NEUTRAL
OK
NOT ALLOWED
OK
Automatic Transmission
NOT ALLOWED
OK
NOT ALLOWED
OK
5
300 STARTING AND OPERATING
This vehicle may be towed on a flatbed or vehicle trailer
provided all four wheels are OFF the ground.
This vehicle may also be towed using a tow dolly (with
the front wheels OFF the ground).
Vehicles equipped with manual transmissions may be
flat towed (with all four wheels on the ground) at any
legal highway speed, for any distance, if the manual
transmission is in NEUTRAL.
CAUTION!
DO NOT flat tow any vehicle equipped with an
automatic transmission. Damage to the drivetrain
will result. If these vehicles require towing, make
sure all drive wheels are OFF the ground.
CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
䡵 HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS . . . . . . . . . . .303 䡵 JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS . . . . . . . . . . . .303
▫ Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 TIRE SERVICE KIT — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . .304
▫ Spare Tire Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tire Service Kit Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
▫ Preparations For Jacking . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tire Service Kit Components And Operation . .305
▫ Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Tire Service Kit Usage Precautions. . . . . . . . . .306
▫ Road Tire Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Sealing A Tire With Tire Service Kit . . . . . . . . .309
▫ Spare Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315 䡵 JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURE . . . . . .
▫ Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
. . . . . .316
. . . . . .317
. . . . . .318
. . . . . .320
. . . . . .321
. . . . . .327
. . . . . .329
. . . . . .329
▫ Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . .330
6
302 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
▫ Jump-Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
䡵 FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
䡵 SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335 䡵 ENHANCED ACCIDENT RESPONSE
SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
䡵 TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . .337
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 303
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located on the In any of the following situations, you can reduce the
instrument panel below the radio.
potential for overheating by taking the appropriate action.
Push the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning
flashers. When the switch is activated, all direc- • On the highways — slow down.
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming • In city traffic — while stopped, place the transmission
traffic of an emergency. Push the switch a second time to
in NEUTRAL, but do not increase engine idle speed.
turn off the Hazard Warning flashers.
NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down
Do not use this emergency warning system when the an impending overheat condition:
vehicle is in motion. Use it when your vehicle is disabled
• If your air conditioner (A/C) is on, turn it off. The A/C
and it is creating a safety hazard for other motorists.
system adds heat to the engine cooling system and
If it is necessary to leave the vehicle to go for service, the
turning the A/C off can help remove this heat.
Hazard Warning flashers will continue to operate with
• You can also turn the temperature control to maximum
the ignition key removed and the vehicle locked.
heat, the mode control to floor and the blower control
NOTE: With extended use, the Hazard Warning flashers
to high. This allows the heater core to act as a
may wear down your battery.
supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat
from the engine cooling system.
6
304 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
WARNING! (Continued)
Driving with a hot cooling system could damage
your vehicle. If the pointer rises to the H (red) mark,
the instrument cluster will sound a chime. When
safe, pull over and stop the vehicle with the engine at
idle. Turn off the air conditioning and wait until the
pointer drops back into the normal range. If the
pointer remains on the H (red) mark for more than a
minute, turn the engine off immediately and call for
service.
to cool. Never try to open a cooling system pressure
cap when the radiator or coolant bottle is hot.
WARNING!
You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had time
(Continued)
TIRE SERVICE KIT — IF EQUIPPED
Small punctures up to ¼” (6 mm) in the tire tread can be
sealed with Tire Service Kit. Foreign objects (e.g., screws
or nails) should not be removed from the tire. Tire Service
Kit can be used in outside temperatures down to approximately -4°F (-20°C).
This kit will provide a temporary tire seal, allowing you
to drive your vehicle up to 100 miles (160 km) with a
maximum speed of 55 mph (90 km/h).
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 305
Tire Service Kit Storage
Tire Service Kit Components And Operation
The Tire Service Kit is located under the front driver’s
seat.
6
Tire Service Kit Components
Tire Service Kit Location
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Sealant Bottle
Deflation Button
Pressure Gauge
Power Button
5 — Mode Select Knob
6 — Sealant Hose (Clear)
7 — Air Pump Hose (Black)
8 — Power Plug (located on the bottom side of the Tire Service Kit)
306 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Using The Mode Select Knob And Hoses
Using The Power Button
Your Tire Service Kit is equipped with the following
Push and release the Power Button (4) once to
symbols to indicate the air or sealant mode.
turn On the Tire Service Kit. Push and release the Power
Button (4) again to turn Off the Tire Service Kit.
Selecting Air Mode
Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to this Using The Deflation Button
position for air pump operation only. Use the
Push the Deflation Button (2) to reduce the air
Black Air Pump Hose (7) when selecting this mode.
pressure in the tire if it becomes over-inflated.
Selecting Sealant Mode
Tire Service Kit Usage Precautions
Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to this • Replace the Tire Service Kit Sealant Bottle (1) and
position to inject the Tire Service Kit Sealant and
Sealant Hose (6) prior to the expiration date (printed at
to inflate the tire. Use the Sealant Hose (clear hose) (6)
the lower right hand corner on the bottle label) to
when selecting this mode.
assure optimum operation of the system. Refer to
“Sealing a Tire with Tire Service Kit” section (F)
“Sealant Bottle and Hose Replacement”.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 307
from the vehicle or tire and wheel components. Once
the sealant dries, it can easily be peeled off and
properly discarded.
• For optimum performance, make sure the valve stem
on the wheel is free of debris before connecting the Tire
Service Kit.
• You can use the Tire Service Kit air pump to inflate
bicycle tires. The kit also comes with two needles,
located in the Accessory Storage Compartment (on the
bottom of the air pump) for inflating sport balls, rafts,
or similar inflatable items. However, use only the Air
Tire Service Kit Expiration Date Location
Pump Hose (7) and make sure the Mode Select Knob
• The Sealant Bottle (1) and Sealant Hose (6) are a one
(5) is in the Air Mode when inflating such items to
tire application use and need to be replaced after each
avoid injecting sealant into them. The Tire Service Kit
use. Always replace these components immediately at
Sealant is only intended to seal punctures less than ¼”
your original equipment vehicle dealer.
(6 mm) diameter in the tread of your vehicle.
• When the Tire Service Kit sealant is in a liquid form, • Do not lift or carry the Tire Service Kit by the hoses.
clean water, and a damp cloth will remove the material
6
308 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not attempt to seal a tire on the side of the
vehicle closest to traffic. Pull far enough off the
road to avoid the danger of being hit when using
the Tire Service Kit.
• Do not use Tire Service Kit or drive the vehicle
under the following circumstances:
– If the puncture in the tire tread is approximately
1/4” (6 mm) or larger.
– If the tire has any sidewall damage.
– If the tire has any damage from driving with
extremely low tire pressure.
– If the tire has any damage from driving on a flat
tire.
– If the wheel has any damage.
– If you are unsure of the condition of the tire or
the wheel.
• Keep Tire Service Kit away from open flames or
heat source.
• A loose Tire Service Kit thrown forward in a
collision or hard stop could endanger the occupants
of the vehicle. Always stow the Tire Service Kit in
the place provided. Failure to follow these warnings can result in injuries that are serious or fatal to
you, your passengers, and others around you.
• Take care not to allow the contents of Tire Service
Kit to come in contact with hair, eyes, or clothing.
Tire Service Kit is harmful if inhaled, swallowed,
or absorbed through the skin. It causes skin, eye,
and respiratory irritation. Flush immediately with
plenty of water if there is any contact with eyes or
skin. Change clothing as soon as possible, if there
is any contact with clothing.
(Continued)
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 309
WARNING! (Continued)
• Tire Service Kit Sealant solution contains latex. In
case of an allergic reaction or rash, consult a physician immediately. Keep Tire Service Kit out of
reach of children. If swallowed, rinse mouth immediately with plenty of water and drink plenty of
water. Do not induce vomiting! Consult a physician
immediately.
Sealing A Tire With Tire Service Kit
(A) Whenever You Stop To Use Tire Service Kit:
1. Pull over to a safe location and turn on the vehicle’s
Hazard Warning flashers.
on the ground. This will provide the best positioning
of the kit when injecting the sealant into the deflated
tire and running the air pump. Move the vehicle as
necessary to place the valve stem in this position
before proceeding.
3. Place the transmission in PARK (auto transmission) or
in Gear (manual transmission) and place the ignition
in the OFF position.
4. Set the parking brake.
(B) Setting Up To Use Tire Service Kit:
1. Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to the
Sealant Mode position.
2. Uncoil the Sealant Hose (6) and then remove the cap
2. Verify that the valve stem (on the wheel with the
from the fitting at the end of the hose.
deflated tire) is in a position that is near to the ground.
This will allow the Tire Service Kit Hoses (6) and (7) to 3. Place the Tire Service Kit flat on the ground next to the
deflated tire.
reach the valve stem and keep the Tire Service Kit flat
6
310 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
4. Remove the cap from the valve stem and then screw NOTE: Sealant may leak out through the puncture in the
the fitting at the end of the Sealant Hose (6) onto the tire.
valve stem.
If the sealant (white fluid) does not flow within 0 – 10
5. Uncoil the Power Plug (8) and insert the plug into the seconds through the Sealant Hose (6):
vehicle’s 12 Volt power outlet.
1. Push the Power Button (4) to turn Off the Tire Service
NOTE: Do not remove foreign objects (e.g., screws or
nails) from the tire.
(C) Injecting Tire Service Kit Sealant Into The
Deflated Tire:
• Always start the engine before turning ON the Tire
Service Kit.
Kit. Disconnect the Sealant Hose (6) from the valve
stem. Make sure the valve stem is free of debris.
Reconnect the Sealant Hose (6) to the valve stem.
Check that the Mode Select Knob (5) is in the Sealant
Mode position and not Air Mode. Push the Power
Button (4) to turn On the Tire Service Kit.
2. Connect the Power Plug (8) to a different 12 Volt
power outlet in your vehicle or another vehicle, if
NOTE: Manual transmission vehicles must have the
available. Make sure the engine is running before
parking brake engaged and the shift lever in NEUTRAL.
turning ON the Tire Service Kit.
• After pushing the Power Button (4), the sealant (white
fluid) will flow from the Sealant Bottle (1) through the 3. The Sealant Bottle (1) may be empty due to previous
use. Call for assistance.
Sealant Hose (6) and into the tire.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 311
NOTE: If the Mode Select Knob (5) is on Air Mode and
the pump is operating, air will dispense from the Air
Pump Hose (7) only, not the Sealant Hose (6).
latch pillar (recommended pressure). Check the tire
pressure by looking at the Pressure Gauge (3).
If the tire does not inflate to at least 26 psi (1.8 Bar)
If the sealant (white fluid) does flow through the pressure within 15 minutes:
Sealant Hose (6):
• The tire is too badly damaged. Do not attempt to drive
the vehicle further. Call for assistance.
1. Continue to operate the pump until sealant is no
longer flowing through hose (typically takes 30 - 70
NOTE: If the tire becomes over-inflated, push the Deflaseconds). As the sealant flows through the Sealant
tion Button to reduce the tire pressure to the recomHose (6), the Pressure Gauge (3) can read as high as 70
mended inflation pressure before continuing.
psi (4.8 Bar). The Pressure Gauge (3) will decrease
quickly from approximately 70 psi (4.8 Bar) to the If the tire inflates to the recommended pressure or is at
actual tire pressure when the Sealant Bottle (1) is least 26 psi (1.8 Bar) pressure within 15 minutes:
empty.
1. Push the Power Button (4) to turn off the Tire Service
Kit.
2. The pump will start to inject air into the tire immediately after the Sealant Bottle (1) is empty. Continue to
2. Remove the Speed Limit sticker from the top of the
operate the pump and inflate the tire to the pressure
Sealant Bottle (1) and place the sticker on the instruindicated on the tire pressure label on the driver-side
ment panel.
6
312 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
3. Immediately disconnect the Sealant Hose (6) from the
valve stem, reinstall the cap on the fitting at the end of
the hose, and place the Tire Service Kit in the vehicle
storage location. Quickly proceed to (D) “Drive Vehicle.”
(D) Drive Vehicle:
Immediately after injecting sealant and inflating the tire,
drive the vehicle 5 miles (8 km) or 10 minutes to ensure
distribution of the Tire Service Kit Sealant within the tire.
Do not exceed 55 mph (90 km/h).
CAUTION!
WARNING!
• The metal end fitting from Power Plug (8) may get
hot after use, so it should be handled carefully.
• Failure to reinstall the cap on the fitting at the end
of the Sealant Hose (6) can result in sealant contacting your skin, clothing, and the vehicle’s interior. It can also result in sealant contacting internal
Tire Service Kit components which may cause
permanent damage to the kit.
Tire Service Kit is not a permanent flat tire repair.
Have the tire inspected and repaired or replaced after
using Tire Service Kit. Do not exceed 55 mph (90
km/h) until the tire is repaired or replaced. Failure to
follow this warning can result in injuries that are
serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others
around you.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 313
(E) After Driving:
If the tire pressure is 19 psi (1.3 Bar) or higher:
Pull over to a safe location. Refer to “Whenever You Stop 1. Push the Power Button (4) to turn on Tire Service Kit
to Use Tire Service Kit” before continuing.
and inflate the tire to the pressure indicated on the tire
and loading information label on the driver-side door
1. Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to the Air
opening.
Mode position.
2. Uncoil the power plug and insert the plug into the NOTE: If the tire becomes over-inflated, push the Deflation Button to reduce the tire pressure to the recomvehicle’s 12 Volt power outlet.
mended inflation pressure before continuing.
3. Uncoil the Air Pump Hose (7) (black in color) and
screw the fitting at the end of hose (7) onto the valve 2. Disconnect the Tire Service Kit from the valve stem,
reinstall the cap on the valve stem and unplug from 12
stem.
Volt outlet.
4. Check the pressure in the tire by reading the Pressure
3. Place the Tire Service Kit in its proper storage area in
Gauge (3).
the vehicle.
If tire pressure is less than 19 psi (1.3 Bar):
4. Have the tire inspected and repaired or replaced at the
The tire is too badly damaged. Do not attempt to drive
earliest opportunity at an authorized dealer or tire
the vehicle further. Call for assistance.
service center.
6
314 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
5. Remove the Speed Limit sticker from the instrument 4. Clean any remaining sealant from the Tire Service Kit
housing.
panel after the tire has been repaired.
6. Replace the Sealant Bottle (1) and Sealant Hose (6) 5. Position the new Sealant Bottle (1) in the housing so
that the Sealant Hose (6) aligns with the hose slot in
assembly at your authorized dealer as soon as posthe front of the housing. Push the bottle into the
sible. Refer to (F) “Sealant Bottle and Hose Replacehousing. An audible click will be heard indicating the
ment”.
bottle is locked into place.
NOTE: When having the tire serviced, advise the authorized dealer or service center that the tire has been sealed 6. Verify that the cap is installed on the fitting at the end
of the Sealant Hose (6) and return the hose to its
using the Tire Service Kit.
storage area (located on the bottom of the air pump).
(F) Sealant Bottle And Hose Replacement:
7. Return the Tire Service Kit to its storage location in the
1. Uncoil the Sealant Hose (6) (clear in color).
vehicle.
2. Locate the round Sealant Bottle release button in the
recessed area under the sealant bottle.
3. Push the Sealant Bottle release button. The Sealant
Bottle (1) will pop up. Remove the bottle and dispose
of it accordingly.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 315
**Use only your Authorized Dealer recommended lug
nuts/bolts and clean or remove any dirt or oil before
Proper lug nut/bolt torque is very important to ensure
tightening.
that the wheel is properly mounted to the vehicle. Any
time a wheel has been removed and reinstalled on the Inspect the wheel mounting surface prior to mounting
vehicle the lug nuts/bolts should be torqued using a the tire and remove any corrosion or loose particles.
properly calibrated torque wrench.
WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Torque Specifications
Lug Nut/Bolt Torque
**Lug Nut/
Bolt Size
66 Ft-Lbs (90 N·m)
Steel Wheels Only
75 Ft-Lbs (100 N·m)
Aluminum Wheels
Only
M12 x 1.25
Lug Nut/
Bolt Socket
Size
17 mm
6
Wheel Mounting Surface
316 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Tighten the lug nuts/bolts in a star pattern until each
nut/bolt has been tightened twice.
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle has
been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
JACKING AND TIRE CHANGING — IF EQUIPPED
WARNING!
Torque Patterns
After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut/bolt torque to be
sure that all the lug nuts/bolts are properly seated
against the wheel.
• Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
• Being under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous. The
vehicle could slip off the jack and fall on you. You
could be crushed. Never put any part of your body
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 317
WARNING! (Continued)
under a vehicle that is on a jack. If you need to get
under a raised vehicle, take it to a service center
where it can be raised on a lift.
• Never start or run the engine while the vehicle is
on a jack.
• The jack is designed to be used as a tool for
changing tires only. The jack should not be used to
lift the vehicle for service purposes. The vehicle
should be jacked on a firm level surface only.
Avoid ice or slippery areas.
Jack Location
The jack and jack wrench tool are stowed in a bag under
the front driver’s seat.
6
Jack And Jack-Handle Location
318 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
2. Fit the wrench tool over the drive nut. Use the wrench
to rotate the nut counterclockwise until the spare is on
The spare tire is stowed to the underbody below the
the ground with enough slack in the cable to allow you
cargo area.
to pull the tire out from under the vehicle.
1. Remove the plug located in the rear cargo area.
Spare Tire Removal
Lowering/Raising Spare Tire
Winch Access Plug
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 319
CAUTION!
The winch mechanism is designed for use with the
jack wrench tool only. Use of an air wrench or other
power tools is not recommended and they can damage the winch.
3. Pull the spare tire out from under the vehicle.
6
Spare Tire
320 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
4. Tilt the retainer at the end of the cable and pull it
through the center of the wheel.
WARNING!
Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the
vehicle close to moving traffic, pull far enough off
the road to avoid the danger of being hit when
operating the jack or changing the wheel.
2. Turn on the Hazard Warning flashers.
3. Set the parking brake.
4. Place the shift lever in PARK (automatic transmission)
or REVERSE (manual transmission).
5. Turn Off the ignition.
Retainer
Preparations For Jacking
1. Park the vehicle on a firm level surface, avoiding ice or
slippery areas.
6. Block both the front and rear of the wheel diagonally
opposite of the jacking position. For example, if changing the right front tire,
block the left rear wheel.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 321
NOTE: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle
while the vehicle is being jacked.
Jacking Instructions
WARNING!
Carefully follow these tire changing warnings to
help prevent personal injury or damage to your
vehicle:
• Always park on a firm, level surface as far from the
edge of the roadway as possible before raising the
vehicle.
• Turn on the Hazard Warning flashers.
• Block the wheel diagonally opposite the wheel to
be raised.
• Set the parking brake firmly and set an automatic
transmission in PARK; a manual transmission in
REVERSE.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Never start or run the engine with the vehicle on a
jack.
• Do not let anyone sit in the vehicle when it is on a
jack.
• Do not get under the vehicle when it is on a jack. If
you need to get under a raised vehicle, take it to a
service center where it can be raised on a lift.
• Only use the jack in the positions indicated and for
lifting this vehicle during a tire change.
• If working on or near a roadway, be extremely
careful of motor traffic.
• To assure that spare tires, flat or inflated, are
securely stowed, spares must be stowed with the
valve stem facing the ground.
6
322 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
2. Remove center cap.
Jack Warning Label
NOTE: Refer to the “Compact Spare Tire” section of the
“Tires-General Information” under “Starting And Operating” for information about the spare tire, it’s use, and
operation.
CAUTION!
Do not attempt to raise the vehicle by jacking on
locations other than those indicated in the Jacking
Instructions for this vehicle.
Center Cap Removal
NOTE: Before using the swivel wrench to remove the
wheel bolts be sure to remove the center cap of the wheel
by inserting the angled tab end of the swivel wrench into
1. Remove the scissors jack and tool bag from under the the notched part of the center cap.
driver’s seat.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 323
3. Loosen, but do not remove, the wheel bolts by turning
them to the left one turn while the wheel is still on the
ground.
NOTE: There are front and rear jacking locations on each
side of the body (as indicated by the triangular lift point
symbol on the sill molding).
6
Rear Jacking Location
Front Jacking Location
324 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Do not raise the vehicle until you are sure the jack is
securely engaged.
4. Turn the jack screw to the left until the jack can be
placed under the jacking location. Once the jack is
positioned, turn the jack screw to the right until the
jack head is properly engaged with the lift area closest
to the wheel to be changed.
Jack Location
WARNING!
Raising the vehicle higher than necessary can make
the vehicle less stable. It could slip off the jack and
hurt someone near it. Raise the vehicle only enough
to remove the tire.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 325
5. Using the swivel wrench, raise the vehicle by turning
the jack screw to the right. Raise the vehicle only until
the tire just clears the surface and enough clearance is
obtained to install the spare tire. Minimum tire lift
provides maximum stability.
6. Remove the wheel bolts and pull the wheel off the
hub. For vehicles equipped with aluminum wheels,
the center caps must be removed to remove the wheel
bolts. For vehicles equipped with steel wheels the
wheel covers must be removed to remove the wheel
bolts.
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not fully tighten the wheel bolts until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in serious injury.
CAUTION!
Be sure to mount the spare tire with the valve stem
facing outward. The vehicle could be damaged if the
spare tire is mounted incorrectly.
WARNING!
To avoid possible personal injury, handle the wheel
covers with care to avoid contact with any sharp
edges.
7. Install the spare wheel and wheel bolts with the cone
shaped end of the bolts toward the wheel. Lightly
tighten the bolts. To avoid the risk of forcing the
vehicle off the jack, do not tighten the bolts fully until
the vehicle has been lowered.
8. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack screw to the left.
6
326 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
9. Finish tightening the wheel bolts. Push down on the
WARNING!
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
leverage. Tighten the wheel bolts in a star pattern until A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision or
each bolt has been tightened twice. For the correct hard stop could endanger the occupants of the vewheel bolt torque refer to Torque Specifications in this hicle. Always stow the jack parts and the spare tire in
section. If in doubt about the correct tightness, have the places provided.
them checked with a torque wrench by your autho11. Place the deflated (flat) tire in the cargo area. Have
rized dealership or service station.
the tire repaired or replaced as soon as possible.
10. Disassemble the jack and tools and place them in the
bag. Stow it under the driver’s seat and secure the
WARNING!
bag to the floor with the straps attached to the floor
of the vehicle.
A loose tire thrown forward in a collision or hard
stop could injure the occupants in the vehicle. Have
the deflated (flat) tire repaired or replaced immediately.
12. Check the spare tire pressure as soon as possible.
Correct the tire pressure as required.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 327
Road Tire Installation
Vehicles Equipped With Wheel Covers
1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
2. Align the valve notch in the wheel cover with the
valve stem on the wheel. Install the cover by hand. Do
not use a hammer or excessive force to install the
cover.
6
Tire And Wheel Cover Or Center Cap
1 — Valve Stem
2 — Valve Notch
3 — Wheel Bolt
4 — Wheel Cover
5 — Road Wheel
328 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
3. Install the four wheel bolts with the cone shaped end 6. After 25 miles (40 km) check the wheel bolt torque
of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the wheel
with a torque wrench to ensure that all wheel bolts are
bolts.
properly seated against the wheel.
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the wheel bolts fully until the vehicle
has been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
4. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
handle counterclockwise.
5. Finish tightening the wheel bolts. Push down on the
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
leverage. Refer to “Torque Specifications” in this section for correct wheel bolt torque.
Vehicles Without Wheel Covers
1. Mount the road tire on the axle.
2. Install the remaining wheel bolts with the cone shaped
end of the nut toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the
wheel bolts.
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not fully tighten the lug nuts until the vehicle has
been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in serious injury.
3. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack
handle counterclockwise.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 329
4. Finish tightening the wheel bolts. Push down on the
wrench while at the end of the handle for increased
leverage. Refer to “Torque Specifications” in this section for correct wheel bolt torque.
JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURE
If your vehicle has a discharged battery, it can be jumpstarted using a set of jumper cables and a battery in
another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster
5. After 25 miles (40 km) check the wheel bolt torque pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly
with a torque wrench to ensure that all wheel bolts are so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
properly seated against the wheel.
NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack,
Spare Tire Stowage
follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions and
precautions.
Reverse instructions of the spare removal section.
Rotate the jack wrench tool on the winch drive nut
clockwise until effort becomes heavy and an audible click
is heard indicating the spare is properly stowed.
CAUTION!
The winch mechanism is designed for use with the
jack wrench extension tool only. Use of air wrench or
power tool may damage the winch.
WARNING!
Do not attempt jump-starting if the battery is frozen.
It could rupture or explode and cause personal injury.
6
330 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION!
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system voltage greater
than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, starter motor,
alternator or electrical system may occur.
Preparations For Jump-Start
The battery in your vehicle is located between the left
front headlight assembly and the left front wheel splash
shield.
Battery Posts
1 — Positive (+) Post (Covered With Protective Cap)
2 — Negative (-) Post
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 331
WARNING!
• Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be injured by
moving fan blades.
• Remove any metal jewelry such as rings, watch
bands and bracelets that could make an inadvertent
electrical contact. You could be seriously injured.
• Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn your
skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas which is
flammable and explosive. Keep open flames or
sparks away from the battery.
1. Set the parking brake, shift the automatic transmission
into PARK and turn the ignition to LOCK.
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
3. Remove the protective cover over the positive (+)
battery post. To remove the cover, push the locking tab
and pull upward on the cover.
4. If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park
the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the
parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this
could establish a ground connection and personal
injury could result.
6
332 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Failure to follow this jump-starting procedure could
result in personal injury or property damage due to
battery explosion.
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
damage to the charging system of the booster vehicle
or the discharged vehicle.
Connecting The Jumper Cables
1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the
positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable to the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
3. Connect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable to the
negative (-) post of the booster battery.
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper
cable to a good engine ground (exposed metal part of
the discharged vehicle’s engine) away from the battery
and the fuel injection system.
WARNING!
Do not connect the jumper cable to the negative (-)
post of the discharged battery. The resulting electrical spark could cause the battery to explode and
could result in personal injury. Only use the specific
ground point, do not use any other exposed metal
parts.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 333
5. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle,
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then you should have the battery and charging system instart the engine in the vehicle with the discharged spected at your authorized dealer.
battery.
6. Once the engine is started, remove the jumper cables
in the reverse sequence:
Disconnecting The Jumper Cables
1. Disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable from the
engine ground (-) of the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
2. Disconnect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable
from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
CAUTION!
Accessories plugged into the vehicle power outlets
draw power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not
in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough without engine operation,
the vehicle’s battery will discharge sufficiently to
degrade battery life and/or prevent the engine from
starting.
FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
3. Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable from the positive (+) post of the booster battery. If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand or snow, it
can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the
4. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the
from the positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE
6
334 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
and REVERSE (with automatic transmission) or 2nd gear
and REVERSE (with manual transmission), while gently
pushing the accelerator. Use the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure that will maintain the rocking motion,
without spinning the wheels, or racing the engine.
NOTE: Push the ⬙ESC Off⬙ switch, to place the Electronic
Stability Control (ESC) system in ⬙Partial Off⬙ mode,
before rocking the vehicle. Refer to “Electronic Brake
Control” in “Starting And Operating” for further information. Once the vehicle has been freed, push the ⬙ESC
Off⬙ switch again to restore ⬙ESC On⬙ mode.
CAUTION!
Racing the engine or spinning the wheels may lead to
transmission overheating and failure. Allow the engine to idle with the transmission in NEUTRAL for at
least one minute after every five rocking-motion
cycles. This will minimize overheating and reduce
the risk of clutch or transmission failure during
prolonged efforts to free a stuck vehicle.
CAUTION!
• When “rocking” a stuck vehicle by shifting between DRIVE/2nd gear and REVERSE, do not spin
the wheels faster than 15 mph (24 km/h), or drivetrain damage may result.
• Revving the engine or spinning the wheels too fast
may lead to transmission overheating and failure.
It can also damage the tires. Do not spin the wheels
above 30 mph (48 km/h) while in gear (no transmission shifting occurring).
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 335
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the axle and tires. A tire could
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for
longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
SHIFT LEVER OVERRIDE
If a malfunction occurs and the shift lever cannot be
moved out of the PARK position, you can use the
following procedure to temporarily move the shift lever:
1. Turn the engine OFF.
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.
3. Remove the shift lever override access cover (located
on the right side of the shift lever housing) by prying
at the bottom edge of the cover.
6
336 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
4. Push and maintain firm pressure on the brake pedal.
5. Insert a small screwdriver or similar tool into the
access hole, and push and hold the override release
lever in.
6. Move the shift lever to the NEUTRAL position.
7. The vehicle may then be started in NEUTRAL.
8. Reinstall the shift lever override access cover.
Shift Lever Override Access Hole
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 337
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
This section describes procedures for towing a disabled vehicle using a commercial towing service.
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Wheel Lift
Flatbed
Wheels OFF The
Ground
NONE
Rear
Front
ALL
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
NOT ALLOWED
NOT ALLOWED
OK
BEST METHOD
MANUAL
TRANSMISSION
If transmission is
operable:
• Transmission in
NEUTRAL
• 65 mph (104 km/h)
max speed
NOT ALLOWED
OK
BEST METHOD
6
338 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Proper towing or lifting equipment is required to prevent
damage to your vehicle. Use only tow bars and other
equipment designed for this purpose, following equipment manufacturer’s instructions. Use of safety chains is
mandatory. Attach a tow bar or other towing device to
main structural members of the vehicle, not to bumpers
or associated brackets. State and local laws regarding
vehicles under tow must be observed.
Automatic Transmission
• Vehicle can be towed with the front wheels elevated.
• Vehicle can be towed on a flatbed truck (all wheels off
the ground).
If the ignition key is unavailable, or the battery is
discharged, refer to “Shift Lever Override” in this section
for instructions on shifting the transmission out of PARK
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.)
while being towed, the ignition must be in the ON/RUN in order to move the vehicle.
position.
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
• Do not use sling-type equipment when towing.
Vehicle damage may occur.
• When securing the vehicle to a flatbed truck, do not
attach to front or rear suspension components.
Damage to your vehicle may result from improper
towing.
• DO NOT flat tow any vehicle equipped with a
conventional automatic transmission. Damage to
the drivetrain will result. If these vehicles require
towing, make sure all drive wheels are OFF the
ground.
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 339
CAUTION! (Continued)
CAUTION!
• Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage.
Damage from improper towing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe engine and/or transmission
damage. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Manual Transmission
ENHANCED ACCIDENT RESPONSE SYSTEM
• Vehicle can be flat towed (all four wheels on the
In the event of an impact causing airbag deployment, if
ground) with the transmission in NEUTRAL.
the communication network remains intact, and the
• Vehicle can be towed with the front wheels elevated. power remains intact, depending on the nature of the
event the ORC will determine whether to have the
• Vehicle can be towed on a flatbed truck (all wheels off
Enhanced Accident Response System perform the followthe ground).
ing functions:
• Cut off fuel to the engine.
6
340 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or System Reset Procedure
until the ignition key is turned off.
After an impact causing airbag deployment, the left and
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as right turn signal lights, located in the instrument panel
the battery has power or until the ignition key is cluster, will both be blinking, until the ignition is turned
removed.
off.
• Unlock the doors automatically.
After the event occurs, when the system is active, the
message ⬙Fuel Cutoff See Handbook⬙ is displayed.
Carefully check the vehicle for fuel leaks in the engine
compartment and on the ground near the engine compartment and fuel tank before resetting the system and
starting the engine.
In order to move your vehicle to the side of the road you
must follow the system reset procedure.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 341
Customer Action
1. Turn ignition OFF.
(Turn Signal Switch Must
be placed in Neutral
State).
2. Turn ignition ON.
3. Turn Right Turn Signal
Switch ON.
4. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch ON.
5. Turn Right Turn Signal
Switch ON.
Customer Will See
Left Turn Light is OFF.
Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Left Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
6. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch ON.
7. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch OFF. (Turn Signal
Switch Must be placed in
Neutral State).
8. Turn ignition OFF.
Left Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Right Turn Light
is ON SOLID.
Left Turn Light is OFF.
Right Turn Light is OFF.
System is now reset and
the engine may be
started.
9. Turn Hazard Flashers
OFF (Manually).
If a reset procedure step is not completed within 45
seconds, then the turn signal lights will turn off and the
reset procedure must be performed again in order to be
successful.
6
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 1.4L . . . . . . . . . .345
▫ Engine Air Cleaner Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 1.4L TURBO . . . .346
▫ Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
䡵 ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II . .347
▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
䡵 EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
PROGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
䡵 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
䡵 DEALER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
䡵 MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .350
▫ Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
▫ Engine Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
▫ Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
▫ Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
▫ Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
▫ Manual Transmission — If Equipped . . . . . . .374
7
344 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Automatic Transmission — If Equipped . . . . .374
▫ Appearance Care And Protection From
Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
▫ Front Turn Signal, Parking And Daytime Running
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Front Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .394
▫ Convertible Top Care — If Equipped . . . . . . .383
▫ Front/Rear Side Marker Lamps. . . . . . . . . . . .395
䡵 FUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
▫ Rear Tail, Stop, Backup And Turn Signal
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .395
▫ Interior Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386
▫ Underhood Fuses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388
䡵 VEHICLE STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
䡵 REPLACEMENT BULBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
䡵 BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
▫ Headlamps Low Beam and High Beam . . . . . .393
▫ Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL). . .396
䡵 FLUID CAPACITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
䡵 FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS, AND GENUINE
PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
▫ Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
▫ Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 345
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 1.4L
7
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Engine Coolant Reservoir
Engine Oil Dipstick
Brake Fluid Reservoir
Front Distribution Unit (Fuses)
5
6
7
8
— Battery
— Air Cleaner Filter
— Engine Oil Fill
— Washer Fluid Reservoir
346 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 1.4L TURBO
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Engine Coolant Reservoir
Engine Oil Dipstick
Brake Fluid Reservoir
Front Distribution Unit (Fuses)
5 — Battery
6 — Engine Oil Fill
7 — Washer Fluid Reservoir
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 347
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard
diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors
the performance of the emissions, engine, and automatic
transmission control systems. When these systems are
operating properly, your vehicle will provide excellent
performance and fuel economy, as well as engine emissions well within current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system
will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).” It
will also store diagnostic codes and other information to
assist your service technician in making repairs. Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not
need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as
soon as possible.
CAUTION!
• Prolonged driving with the MIL on could cause
further damage to the emission control system. It
could also affect fuel economy and driveability.
The vehicle must be serviced before any emissions
tests can be performed.
• If the MIL is flashing while the engine is running,
severe catalytic converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service is required.
EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
PROGRAMS
In some localities, it may be a legal requirement to pass
an inspection of your vehicle’s emissions control system.
Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.
For states that require an Inspection and Maintenance (I/M), this check verifies the “Malfunction
7
348 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Indicator Light (MIL)” is functioning and is not on when 2. As soon as you cycle the ignition switch to the ON
the engine is running, and that the OBD II system is
position, you will see the Malfunction Indicator Light
ready for testing.
(MIL) symbol come on as part of a normal bulb check.
Normally, the OBD II system will be ready. The OBD II 3. Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things will
system may not be ready if your vehicle was recently
happen:
serviced, recently had a dead battery or a battery replace• The MIL will flash for about 10 seconds and then
ment. If the OBD II system should be determined not
return to being fully illuminated until you turn OFF
ready for the I/M test, your vehicle may fail the test.
the ignition or start the engine. This means that your
Your vehicle has a simple ignition actuated test, which
vehicle’s OBD II system is not ready and you should
you can use prior to going to the test station. To check if
not proceed to the I/M station.
your vehicle’s OBD II system is ready, you must do the
• The MIL will not flash at all and will remain fully
following:
illuminated until you place the ignition in the off
1. Cycle the ignition switch to the ON position, but do
position or start the engine. This means that your
not crank or start the engine.
vehicle’s OBD II system is ready and you can proceed
to the I/M station.
NOTE: If you crank or start the engine, you will have to
start this test over.
If your OBD II system is not ready, you should see your
authorized dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 349
recently serviced or had a battery failure or replacement,
you may need to do nothing more than drive your
vehicle as you normally would in order for your OBD II
system to update. A recheck with the above test routine
may then indicate that the system is now ready.
DEALER SERVICE
Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personnel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service
operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are
available which include detailed service information for
Regardless of whether your vehicle’s OBD II system is your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before
ready or not, if the MIL is illuminated during normal attempting any procedure yourself.
vehicle operation you should have your vehicle serviced NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
before going to the I/M station. The I/M station can fail systems may void your warranty and could result in civil
your vehicle because the MIL is on with the engine penalties being assessed against you.
running.
WARNING!
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Use of genuine parts for normal/scheduled maintenance
and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures caused by the
use of parts which are not quality-equivalent to genuine
parts for maintenance and repairs will not be covered by
the manufacturer’s warranty.
You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Only do service work for which you
have the knowledge and the proper equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
7
350 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
CAUTION! (Continued)
The pages that follow contain the required maintenance
services determined by the engineers who designed your
vehicle.
Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed
maintenance schedule, there are other components which
may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
• Failure to properly maintain your vehicle or perform repairs and service when necessary could
result in more costly repairs, damage to other
components or negatively impact vehicle performance. Immediately have potential malfunctions
examined by an authorized dealer or qualified
repair center.
(Continued)
• Your vehicle has been built with improved fluids
that protect the performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended maintenance intervals. Do not use chemical flushes in these components as the chemicals can damage your engine,
transmission, or air conditioning. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
If a flush is needed because of component malfunction, use only the specified fluid for the flushing
procedure.
Engine Oil
Checking Oil Level
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at
regular intervals, such as every fuel stop. The best time to
check the engine oil level is approximately five minutes
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 351
after a fully warmed engine is shut off. Do not check oil
level before starting the engine after it has sat overnight.
Checking engine oil level when the engine is cold will
give you an incorrect reading.
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground, and
approximately five minutes after a fully warmed engine
is shut off, will improve the accuracy of the oil level
readings. Maintain the oil level between the range markings on the dipstick. The safe range is indicated by a
crosshatch zone. Adding 1 quart (0.9 Liters) of oil when
the reading is at the low end of the indicated range will
result in the oil level at the full end of the indicator range.
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
temperature. This loss of oil pressure and increased
oil temperature could damage your engine.
Change Engine Oil
The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is
time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for further information.
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change intervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or 350 hours of
engine run time or one year, whichever comes first.
Engine Oil Selection — 1.4L Engine
Do not overfill the engine with oil. Overfilling the
engine with oil will cause oil aeration, which can
lead to loss of oil pressure and an increase in oil
(Continued)
For best performance and maximum protection under all
types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
the requirements of FCA US Material Standard MS-6395.
7
352 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Engine Oil Selection — 1.4L Turbo Engine
For best performance and maximum protection under all
types of operating conditions, the manufacturer only
recommends engine oils that are API Certified and meet
the requirements of FCA US Material Standard MS-12991.
American Petroleum Institute (API) Engine Oil
Identification Symbol
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your engine oil as the
chemicals can damage your engine. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Engine Oil Viscosity — 1.4L Engine (SAE Grade)
SAE 5W-30 engine oil recommended for all operating
temperatures. This engine oil improves low temperature
This symbol means that the oil has starting and vehicle fuel economy.
been certified by the American
You may use synthetic engine oils provided the recomPetroleum Institute (API). The
mended oil quality requirements are met, and the recommanufacturer only recommends
mended maintenance intervals for oil and filter changes
API Certified engine oils.
are followed.
Lubricants which do not have both the engine oil certification mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade number should not be used.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 353
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended
engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on
engine oil filler cap location, refer to “Engine Compartment” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
engine oil filler cap location, refer to “Engine Compartment” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
Synthetic Engine Oils
You may use synthetic engine oils provided the recommended oil quality requirements are met, and the recommended maintenance intervals for oil and filter changes
MOPAR® SAE 5W-40 full synthetic engine oil is recom- are followed.
mended for all operating temperatures. This engine oil
Materials Added To Engine Oil
improves low temperature starting and vehicle fuel
The manufacturer strongly recommends against the adeconomy.
dition of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) to
Lubricants which do not have both the engine oil certi- the engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product and its
fication mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade num- performance may be impaired by supplemental addiber should not be used.
tives.
The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended
engine oil viscosity for your engine. For information on
Engine Oil Viscosity — 1.4L Turbo Engine (SAE
Grade)
7
354 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
high quality filters should be used to assure most efficient
service. MOPAR® engine oil filters are high quality oil
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and
filters and are recommended.
oil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters,
indiscriminately discarded, can present a problem to the Engine Air Cleaner Filter
environment. Contact your authorized dealer, service
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
station or governmental agency for advice on how and
maintenance intervals.
where used oil and oil filters can be safely discarded in
your area.
Disposing Of Used Engine Oil And Oil Filters
WARNING!
Engine Oil Filter
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new filter
at every engine oil change.
Engine Oil Filter Selection
This manufacturer’s engines have a full-flow type disposable oil filter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The
quality of replacement filters varies considerably. Only
The air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.) can
provide a measure of protection in the case of engine
backfire. Do not remove the air induction system (air
cleaner, hoses, etc.) unless such removal is necessary
for repair or maintenance. Make sure that no one is
near the engine compartment before starting the
vehicle with the air induction system (air cleaner,
hoses, etc.) removed. Failure to do so can result in
serious personal injury.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 355
Engine Air Cleaner Filter Selection
WARNING! (Continued)
The quality of replacement engine air cleaner filters
varies considerably. Only high quality filters should be
used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR® engine air
cleaner filters are a high quality filter and are recommended.
Maintenance-Free Battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free battery.
You will never have to add water, nor is periodic maintenance required.
WARNING!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can
burn or even blind you. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do not lean
over a battery when attaching clamps. If acid
(Continued)
splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with large amounts of water. Refer to
“Jump-Starting Procedures” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
• Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep
flame or sparks away from the battery. Do not use
a booster battery or any other booster source with
an output greater than 12 Volts. Do not allow cable
clamps to touch each other.
• Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands
after handling.
• The battery in this vehicle has a vent hose that
should not be disconnected and should only be
replaced with a battery of the same type (vented).
7
356 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• It is essential when replacing the cables on the
battery that the positive cable is attached to the
positive post and the negative cable is attached to
the negative post. Battery posts are marked positive
(+) and negative (-) and are identified on the
battery case. Cable clamps should be tight on the
terminal posts and free of corrosion.
• If a “fast charger” is used while the battery is in the
vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Do not
use a “fast charger” to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
For best possible performance, your air conditioner
should be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer
at the start of each warm season. This service should
include cleaning of the condenser fins and a performance
test. Drive belt tension should also be checked at this
time.
WARNING!
• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants
approved by the manufacturer for your air conditioning system. Some unapproved refrigerants are
flammable and can explode, injuring you. Other
unapproved refrigerants or lubricants can cause the
system to fail, requiring costly repairs. Refer to
Warranty Information Book, located on the DVD,
for further warranty information.
• The air conditioning system contains refrigerant
under high pressure. To avoid risk of personal
injury or damage to the system, adding refrigerant
or any repair requiring lines to be disconnected
should be done by an experienced technician.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 357
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
system as the chemicals can damage your air conditioning components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling R134a — If
Equipped
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling HFO 1234yf
— If Equipped
HFO 1234yf Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product
with a low GWP (Global Warming Potential). However,
the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning service be performed by authorized dealer or other service
facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
R-134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system
Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product. How- PAG compressor oil and refrigerants.
ever, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning A/C Air Filter
service be performed by authorized dealer or other
service facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
WARNING!
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system
PAG compressor oil and refrigerants.
Do not remove the A/C air filter while the blower is
operating or personal injury may result.
7
358 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
The A/C air filter is located in the fresh air inlet on the 2. Pull the console closeout cover rearward to disengage
lower right of center console. Perform the following
the front retaining tab and remove the cover.
procedure to replace the filter:
1. Remove the Torx® screw that secures the passenger
side console closeout cover.
Console Closeout Panel
Torx® Screw Location
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 359
3. Remove the two 5.5 mm screws (1 and 2) that secure 4. Remove the A/C air filter by pulling it straight out of
the particulate air filter cover to the HVAC housing.
the housing. Take note of the air filter position indicators.
7
Air Filter Cover Screw Locations
A/C Air Filter
5. Install the A/C air filter with the air filter position
indicators pointing in the same direction as removal.
360 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
The A/C air filter is identified with an arrow to
indicate airflow direction through the filter. Failure
to properly install the filter will result in the need to
replace it more often.
should be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after
lubricating excess oil and grease should be removed.
Particular attention should also be given to hood latching
components to ensure proper function. When performing
other underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a
year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR®
maintenance intervals.
Lock Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.
6. Install the passenger side console closeout.
Body Lubrication
Wiper Blades
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as
seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate,
tailgate, decklid, sliding doors and hood hinges, should
be lubricated periodically with a lithium based grease,
such as MOPAR® Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy
operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to
the application of any lubricant, the parts concerned
Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the
windshield and rear window periodically with a sponge
or soft cloth and a mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will
remove accumulations of salt, waxes, or road film, and
help reduce streaking and smearing.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 361
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods Rear Wiper Blade Removal/Installation
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use
1. Lift the pivot cap on the rear wiper arm upward, this
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt
will allow the rear wiper blade to be raised off of the
from a dry windshield or rear window.
liftgate glass.
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from
the windshield or rear window. Make sure that they are
not frozen to the glass before turning them on to avoid
damaging the blade. Keep the wiper blade out of contact
with petroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depending
on geographical area and frequency of use. Poor performance of blades may be present with chattering, marks,
water lines or wet spots. If any of these conditions are
present, clean the wiper blades or replace as necessary.
7
1 — Wiper Arm
2 — Pivot Cap
362 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The rear wiper arm cannot be raised fully upward unless the pivot cap is raised first.
2. Lift the rear wiper arm upward to raise the wiper
blade off of the liftgate glass.
3. Grab the bottom of the wiper blade and rotate it
forward to unsnap the blade pivot pin from the wiper
blade holder.
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Wiper Blade
Blade Pivot Pin
Wiper Arm
Wiper Blade Holder
4. Install the wiper blade pivot pin into the wiper blade
holder at the end of the wiper arm, and firmly press
the wiper blade until it snaps into place.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 363
5. Lower the wiper blade and snap the pivot cap into Exhaust System
place.
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
Adding Washer Fluid
system.
The windshield washer fluid reservoir is located in the
engine compartment, and the fluid level should be If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system;
checked at regular intervals. Fill the reservoir with wind- or if the exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle;
shield washer solvent (not engine coolant/ antifreeze). or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged;
Refer to “Engine Compartment” in this section for fur- have an authorized technician inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damther information.
aged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams
or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep
WARNING!
into the passenger compartment. In addition, have the
Commercially available windshield washer solvents exhaust system inspected each time the vehicle is raised
are flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
must be exercised when filling or working around
the washer solution.
7
364 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
CAUTION!
• Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain
carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and
odorless. Breathing it can make you unconscious
and can eventually poison you. To avoid breathing
CO, refer to “Safety Tips/Exhaust Gas” in “Things
To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further
information.
• A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park
over materials that can burn. Such materials might
be grass or leaves coming into contact with your
exhaust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in areas where your exhaust system can contact anything that can burn.
• The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the
effectiveness of the catalyst as an emissions control
device and may seriously reduce engine performance and cause serious damage to the engine.
• Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your
vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition.
In the event of engine malfunction, particularly
involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of
performance, have your vehicle serviced promptly.
Continued operation of your vehicle with a severe
malfunction could cause the converter to overheat,
resulting in possible damage to the converter and
vehicle.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 365
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic con- To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter damverter will not require maintenance. However, it is im- age:
portant to keep the engine properly tuned to assure • Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition,
proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst
when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in
damage.
motion.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control • Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed
vehicle.
against you.
• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning
disconnected or removed, such as when diagnostic
engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe
testing, or for prolonged periods during very rough
and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop
idle or malfunctioning operating conditions.
the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool.
Service, including a tune-up to manufacturer’s specifications, should be obtained immediately.
7
366 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cooling System
WARNING!
• When working near the radiator cooling fan, disconnect the fan motor lead or turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position. The fan is temperature
controlled and can start at any time the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
• You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had
time to cool. Never try to open a cooling system
pressure cap when the radiator is hot.
applicable). If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or
rusty in appearance, the system should be drained,
flushed and refilled with fresh engine coolant (antifreeze). Check the front of the A/C condenser for any
accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the
face of the condenser.
Cooling System — Drain, Flush And Refill
NOTE: Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant
properly. Failure to fill these systems properly could lead
to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is
needed to be added to the system please contact your
local authorized dealer.
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains
visible sediment, have an authorized dealer clean and
Coolant Checks
flush with OAT coolant (antifreeze) (conforming to
Check engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12
MS.90032).
months (before the onset of freezing weather, where
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 367
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
Selection Of Coolant
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine Parts” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
CAUTION!
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) or any “globally compatible” coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
(Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, the cooling system will
need to be drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh
OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032), by an authorized dealer as soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
7
368 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Adding Coolant
• Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine coolant
that meets the requirements of FCA Material Standard
MS.90032 and distilled water. Use higher concentrations (not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below −34° F
(−37° C) are anticipated.
Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine
coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS.90032) that allows extended maintenance intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze) can be used up to ten years or 150,000
miles (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reduc- • Use only high purity water such as distilled or deioning this extended maintenance period, it is important that
ized water when mixing the water/engine coolant
you use the same engine coolant (OAT coolant conform(antifreeze) solution. The use of lower quality water
ing to MS.90032) throughout the life of your vehicle.
will reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the
engine cooling system.
Please review these recommendations for using Organic
Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to mainthat meets the requirements of FCA Material Standard tain the proper level of protection against freezing acMS.90032. When adding engine coolant (antifreeze):
cording to the temperatures occurring in the area where
the vehicle is operated.
• We recommend using MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant
10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive
Technology) that meets the requirements of FCA Material Standard MS.90032.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 369
NOTE:
• Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant
properly. Failure to fill these systems properly could
lead to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is
needed to be added to the system please contact your
local authorized dealer.
• Mixing engine coolant (antifreeze) types is not recommended and can result in cooling system damage. If
HOAT and OAT coolant are mixed in an emergency,
have a authorized dealer drain, flush, and refill with
OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032) as soon as
possible.
Cooling System Pressure Cap
The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any
accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces.
WARNING!
• Do not open hot engine cooling system. Never add
engine coolant (antifreeze) when the engine is
overheated. Do not loosen or remove the cap to cool
an overheated engine. Heat causes pressure to
build up in the cooling system. To prevent scalding
or injury, do not remove the pressure cap while the
system is hot or under pressure.
• Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or engine damage may result.
The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of engine
Disposal Of Used Engine Coolant
coolant (antifreeze) and to ensure that engine coolant
(antifreeze) will return to the radiator from the coolant Used ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is
a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. Check
recovery tank.
7
370 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
with your local authorities to determine the disposal
rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by animals or children, do not store ethylene glycol-based
engine coolant in open containers or allow it to remain in
puddles on the ground. If ingested by a child or pet, seek
emergency assistance immediately. Clean up any ground
spills immediately.
When additional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to
maintain the proper level, it should be added to the
coolant bottle. Do not overfill.
Points To Remember
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/
kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor coming
from the front of the engine compartment. This is norCoolant Level
mally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high
The coolant expansion bottle provides a quick visual humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vapormethod for determining that the coolant level is ad- ized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot engine
equate. With the engine off and cold, the level of the coolant (antifreeze) to enter the radiator.
engine coolant (antifreeze) in the bottle should be beIf an examination of your engine compartment shows no
tween the bottom and top lines marked “COLD FILL
evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be
RANGE”.
safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.
As long as the engine operating temperature is satisfac- • Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle.
tory, the coolant bottle need only be checked once a
month.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 371
• Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator and in • Do not change the thermostat for Summer or Winter
the coolant expansion bottle. If engine coolant (antioperation. If replacement is ever necessary, install
ONLY the correct type thermostat. Other designs may
freeze) needs to be added, the contents of the coolant
result in unsatisfactory engine coolant (antifreeze)
expansion bottle must also be protected against freezperformance, poor gas mileage, and increased emising.
sions.
• If frequent engine coolant (antifreeze) additions are
required, the cooling system should be pressure tested Brake System
for leaks.
In order to assure brake system performance, all brake
• Maintain engine coolant (antifreeze) concentration at a system components should be inspected periodically.
minimum of 50% OAT coolant (conforming to Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
MS.90032) and distilled water for proper corrosion maintenance intervals.
protection of your engine which contains aluminum
components.
WARNING!
• Make sure that the coolant expansion bottle overflow
hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
• Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle is
equipped with air conditioning, keep the front of the
condenser clean.
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and
possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or
riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally
(Continued)
7
372 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with a manual
transmission, the brake fluid reservoir supplies fluid to
high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and both the brake system and the clutch release system. The
possible brake damage. Riding the brakes may also two systems are separated in the reservoir, and a leak in
reduce braking capacity in an emergency.
one system will not affect the other system. The manual
transmission clutch release system should not require
Brake Master Cylinder
fluid replacement during the life of the vehicle. If the
The fluid level in the master cylinder should be checked brake fluid reservoir is low and the brake system does
when performing under hood services, or immediately if not indicate any leaks or other problems, it may be a
the “Brake Warning Light” is on.
result of a leak in the hydraulic clutch release system. See
your local authorized dealer for service.
Be sure to clean the top of the master cylinder area before
removing the cap. If necessary, add fluid to bring the Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake fluid. Refluid level up to the requirements described on the brake fer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine Parts” in “Mainfluid reservoir. Fluid level can be expected to fall as the taining Your Vehicle” for further information.
brake pads wear. The brake fluid level should be checked
when the pads are replaced. However, low fluid level
may be caused by a leak and a checkup may be needed.
WARNING! (Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 373
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine
Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid
can severely damage your brake system and/or
impair its performance. The proper type of brake
fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the
original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder
reservoir.
• To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that has
been in a tightly closed container. Keep the master
cylinder reservoir cap secured at all times. Brake
fluid in a open container absorbs moisture from the
air resulting in a lower boiling point. This may
cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in
spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts, causing
the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can also
damage painted and vinyl surfaces, care should be
taken to avoid its contact with these surfaces.
• Do not allow petroleum-based fluid to contaminate
the brake fluid. Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or complete brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
(Continued)
7
374 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Use of improper brake fluids will affect overall
clutch system performance. Improper brake fluids
may damage the clutch system resulting in loss of
clutch function and the ability to shift the transmission.
Manual Transmission — If Equipped
Lubricant Selection
Add fluid, if necessary, to maintain the proper level.
Please see your authorized dealer for service.
Frequency Of Fluid Change
Under normal operating conditions, the fluid installed at
the factory will give satisfactory lubrication for the life of
the vehicle. Fluid changes are not necessary unless lubricant has become contaminated with water.
NOTE: If contaminated with water, the fluid should be
changed immediately.
Use only the manufacturers recommended transmission
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine Parts” in Automatic Transmission — If Equipped
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
Selection Of Lubricant
Fluid Level Check
It is important to use the proper transmission fluid to
Check the fluid level by removing the fill plug. The fluid ensure optimum transmission performance and life. Use
level should be between the bottom of the fill hole and a only the manufacturer’s specified transmission fluid.
point not more than 3/16 inch (4.7 mm) below the bottom Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine Parts” in this
section for fluid specifications. It is important to maintain
of the hole.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 375
the transmission fluid at the correct level using the
recommended fluid. No chemical flushes should be used
in any transmission; only the approved lubricant should
be used.
CAUTION!
Using a transmission fluid other than the manufacturer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality and/or torque converter
shudder. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine
Parts” in this section for fluid specifications.
Special Additives
Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is an engineered
product and its performance may be impaired by supplemental additives. Therefore, do not add any fluid additives to the transmission. The only exception to this
policy is the use of special dyes for diagnosing fluid
leaks. Avoid using transmission sealers as they may
adversely affect seals.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your transmission as
the chemicals can damage your transmission components. Such damage is not covered by the New
Vehicle Limited Warranty.
The manufacturer strongly recommends against using
Fluid Level Check
any special additives in the transmission.
The fluid level is preset at the factory and does not
require adjustment under normal operating conditions.
Routine fluid level checks are not required, therefore the
7
376 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
transmission has no dipstick. Your authorized dealer can
check your transmission fluid level using special service
tools. If you notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunction, visit your authorized dealer immediately to have
the transmission fluid level checked. Operating the vehicle with an improper fluid level can cause severe
transmission damage.
CAUTION!
If a transmission fluid leak occurs, visit your authorized dealer immediately. Severe transmission damage may occur. Your authorized dealer has the proper
tools to adjust the fluid level accurately.
Fluid And Filter Changes
Under normal operating conditions, the fluid installed at
the factory will provide satisfactory lubrication for the
life of the vehicle. Routine fluid and filter changes are not
required. However, change the fluid and filter if the fluid
becomes contaminated (with water, etc.), or if the transmission is disassembled for any reason.
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
Protection Of Body And Paint From Corrosion
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads
passable in snow and ice and those that are sprayed on
trees and road surfaces during other seasons are highly
corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,
which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,
road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme
hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will
have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and underbody protection.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 377
The following maintenance recommendations will enable Washing
you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion • Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your veresistance built into your vehicle.
hicle in the shade using MOPAR® Car Wash, or a mild
car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with
What Causes Corrosion?
clear water.
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of
• If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumupaint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
lated on your vehicle, use MOPAR® Super Kleen Bug
The most common causes are:
and Tar Remover to remove.
• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
• Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR®
• Stone and gravel impact.
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect
your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
• Insects, tree sap and tar.
• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.
• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing
that may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish.
7
378 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials
such as steel wool or scouring powder that will
scratch metal and painted surfaces.
• Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274
kPa) can result in damage or removal of paint and
decals.
• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint,
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is
considered the responsibility of the owner.
• If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar
cause that destroys the paint and protective coating,
have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The
cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of
the owner.
• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers,
de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well
• If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive
packaged and sealed.
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once
a month.
• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
• It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and • Use MOPAR® Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as
open.
possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to
match the color of your vehicle.
Special Care
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 379
Wheel And Wheel Trim Care
• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and
chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly
with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
• To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use
MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Dark Vapor or
Black Satin Chrome wheels DO NOT USE wheel cleaners,
abrasives or polishing compounds. They will permanently damage this finish and such damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. USE ONLY
MILD SOAP AND WATER WITH A SOFT CLOTH. Used
on a regular basis this is all that is required to maintain
this finish.
CAUTION!
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle brush,
or metal polishes. Do not use oven cleaner. These
products may damage the wheel’s protective finish.
Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic solutions
or harsh brushes that may damage the wheel’s protective finish. Only MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner or
equivalent is recommended.
Stain Repel Fabric Cleaning Procedure — If
Equipped
Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following manner:
• Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting
with a clean, dry towel.
• Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
7
380 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• For tough stains, apply MOPAR® Total Clean, or a Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular
mild soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt
stain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue. can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery
and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.
• For grease stains, apply MOPAR® Multi-Purpose
Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth
Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use
and MOPAR® Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoid
a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please
• Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents, or ammonia-based cleaners to clean your leather
protectants on Stain Repel products.
upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not
Interior Care
required to maintain the original condition.
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean fabric upholstery and
carpeting.
WARNING!
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean vinyl upholstery.
MOPAR® Total Clean is specifically recommended for
leather upholstery.
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 381
CAUTION!
Direct contact of air fresheners, insect repellents,
suntan lotions, or hand sanitizers to the plastic,
painted, or decorated surfaces of the interior may
cause permanent damage. Wipe away immediately.
CAUTION!
Damage caused by these type of products may not be
covered by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
CAUTION!
Do not use Alcohol and Alcohol-based and/or Keton
based cleaning products to clean leather seats, as
damage to the seat may result.
Cleaning Headlights
Your vehicle has plastic headlights that are lighter and
less susceptible to stone breakage than glass headlights.
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution followed by rinsing.
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.
7
382 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Glass Surfaces
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis
with MOPAR® Glass Cleaner, or any commercial
household-type glass cleaner. Never use an abrasive type
cleaner. Use caution when cleaning the inside rear window equipped with electric defrosters or windows
equipped with radio antennas. Do not use scrapers or
other sharp instrument that may scratch the elements.
Instrument Panel Bezels
CAUTION!
When installing hanging air fresheners in your vehicle, read the installation instructions carefully.
Some air fresheners will damage the finish of
painted or decorated parts if allowed to directly
contact any surface.
When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses
towel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleaner
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are
directly on the mirror.
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care
Instrument Panel Cover
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
The instrument panel cover has a low glare surface which 1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be
minimizes reflections on the windshield. Do not use
used, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasive
protectants or other products which may cause undesircleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp
able reflections. Use soap and warm water to restore the
rag.
low glare surface.
2. Dry with a soft cloth.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 383
Seat Belt Maintenance
WARNING! (Continued)
Do not bleach, dye or clean the belts with chemical
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric.
Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they
have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, torn webbing, etc.).
If the belts need cleaning, use a mild soap solution or
lukewarm water. Do not remove the belts from the car to Convertible Top Care — If Equipped
wash them. Dry with a soft cloth.
NOTE: Lubricate the top rails with Berulub FR 43 every
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the 2000 cycles or if scratching noises due to dust are present.
buckles do not work properly.
CAUTION!
WARNING!
A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision and
leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose parts.
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do
not disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt
(Continued)
7
Failure to follow these cautions may cause interior
water damage, stains or mildew on the top material:
• Avoid high-pressure car washes, as they can damage the top material. Also, increased water pressure
may force past the weather strips.
(Continued)
384 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Remove any standing water from the top and dry
the surface before opening it. Operating the top,
opening a door or lowering a window while the top
is wet may allow water to drip into the vehicles
interior.
• Use care when washing the vehicle, water pressure
directed at the weather strip seals may cause water
to leak into the vehicles interior.
Immediate removal of any contaminant is recommended.
Regular washing of the top will enhance its life and
appearance, and make successive cleanings easier. Do not
subject the top to excessive heat. Frequently vacuum the
top and storage compartment.
Washing
Hand washing is highly recommended. Automatic car
washing equipment can damage the top material. If you
must use an automatic car wash, soft cloth systems are
preferred.
CAUTION!
Avoid high-pressure car washes, as they can damage
the top material. Also, increased water pressure may
force water past the weather strips.
General Cleaning
Careful vacuuming of the top before washing is helpful
in removing dust and other foreign particles. Wash in
partial shade instead of direct sun. Wet the entire vehicle
before washing the top. The top should be washed with
a soft, natural bristle scrub brush, and a mild soap
solution such as liquid dishwashing soap. Do not use
detergent.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 385
CAUTION!
Never use an abrasive type cleaner or bleaches.
Cleaners should not contain silicones, organic solvents, petroleum distillates, or plasticizers. Always
wait until the top is thoroughly dry before lowering
it into the storage area.
Scrub in all directions, covering an area of about two
square feet at a time. Avoid heavy scrubbing. Rinse the
entire vehicle with water to remove all soap and dirt from
the top fabric and to prevent streaking on painted and
chrome surfaces. Allow the top to dry before lowering.
Vacuuming the top with a wet/dry shop vacuum will
decrease the top’s drying time, ensure removal of all dirt,
and delete streaks in the material. Multiple cleanings
may be necessary to remove stubborn stains. If stains
persist, contact your local authorized dealer for further
suggestions.
FUSES
WARNING!
• When replacing a blown fuse, always use an appropriate replacement fuse with the same amp
rating as the original fuse. Never replace a fuse
with another fuse of higher amp rating. Never
replace a blown fuse with metal wires or any other
material. Failure to use proper fuses may result in
serious personal injury, fire and/or property damage.
• Before replacing a fuse, make sure that the ignition
is off and that all the other services are switched off
and/or disengaged.
• If the replaced fuse blows again, contact an authorized dealer.
(Continued)
7
386 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• If a general protection fuse for safety systems (air
bag system, braking system), power unit systems
(engine system, gearbox system) or steering system
blows, contact an authorized dealer.
Interior Fuses
The interior fuse panel is part of the Body Control
Module (BCM) and is located on the driver’s side under
the instrument panel.
Fuse Panel
Cavity
1
2
Vehicle Fuse Number
F12
F32
Mini Fuse
7.5 Amp Brown
5 Amp Tan
3
F53
5 Amp Tan
Description
Right Low Beam
Front and Rear Ceiling Lights Trunk and Door
Courtesy Lights
Instrument Panel Node
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 387
Cavity
4
5
Vehicle Fuse Number
F38
F36
Mini Fuse
20 Amp Yellow
10 Amp Red
6
7
8
9
10
F43
F48
F13
F50
F51
20 Amp Yellow
20 Amp Yellow
7.5 Amp Brown
7.5 Amp Brown
5 Amp Tan
11
12
F37
F49
5 Amp Tan
5 Amp Tan
13
14
F31
F47
5 Amp Tan
20 Amp Yellow
Description
Central Door Locking
Diagnostic Socket, Car Radio, Climate Control
System
Bi-Directional Washer
Passenger Power Window
Left Low Beam, Headlamp Leveling
Airbag
Car Radio Switch, Climate Control System,
Stop Light, Clutch
Stop Light Switch, Instrument Panel Node
Exterior Mirror, GPS, Electric Mirror, Parking
Sensor
Ignition, Climate Control
Driver Power Window
7
388 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Underhood Fuses
The Front Distribution Unit is located on the right side of
the engine compartment, next to the battery. To access the
fuses, press the release tabs and remove the cover.
Front Distribution Unit
The ID number of the electrical component corresponding to each fuse can be found on the back of the cover.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 389
Cavity
F01
F02
F03
F04
F05
F06
F06
F07
F08
F09
F10
F11
F11
F14
F15
Maxi Fuse
60 Amp Blue
20 Amp Yellow
20 Amp Yellow
40 Amp Orange
70 Amp Tan
20 Amp Yellow
30 Amp Green
40 Amp Orange
40 Amp Orange
–
–
–
–
–
–
Mini Fuse
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
10 Amp Red
10 Amp Red
15 Amp Blue
10 Amp Red
5 Amp Tan
15 Amp Blue
Description
Body Controller
Audio Amplifier
Ignition Switch
Anti-Lock Brake Pump
Electric Power Steering
Radiator Fan - Single Speed
Radiator Fan - Low Speed
Radiator Fan - High Speed
Blower Motor
Powertrain
Horn
Powertrain
Powertrain (Multiair – If Equipped)
High Beam (Shutter)
Cigar Lighter
7
390 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
F16
F17
F17
F18
F18
F19
F20
F21
F22
F23
F24
F30
F82
F83
F84
Maxi Fuse
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
30 Amp Green
20 Amp Yellow
–
Mini Fuse
7.5 Amp Brown
25 Amp Clear
15 Amp Blue
15 Amp Blue
5 Amp Tan
7.5 Amp Brown
15 Amp Blue
15 Amp Blue
20 Amp Yellow
20 Amp Yellow
7.5 Amp Brown
15 Amp Blue
–
–
10 Amp Red
Description
Transmission
Powertrain (Multiair – If Equipped)
Powertrain
Powertrain
Powertrain (Multiair – If Equipped)
Air Conditioning
Heated Seats – If Equipped
Fuel Pump
Powertrain
Anti-Lock Brake Valves
Stability Control System
Fog Lamps
Sunroof/Convertible Top
Cooling Pump – If Equipped
Transmission
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 391
Cavity
F85
F87
F90
Maxi Fuse
30 Amp Green
–
–
Mini Fuse
–
5 Amp Tan
5 Amp Tan
Description
Rear Defroster
Rear Defroster
Heated Mirrors – If Equipped
• Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of
service (i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the
If you will not be using your vehicle for more than 21
air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes
days, you may want to take steps to preserve your
in the fresh air and high blower setting. This will
battery.
ensure adequate system lubrication to minimize the
• Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
possibility of compressor damage when the system is
started again.
VEHICLE STORAGE
NOTE: When the vehicle has not been started or driven
for at least 30 days, an Extended Park Start Procedure is
required to start the vehicle. Refer to “Starting Procedures”
in “Starting And Operating” for further information.
7
392 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
REPLACEMENT BULBS
Interior Bulbs
Overhead Lamp
Courtesy Lamp
Bulb Number
C5W
W5W
Exterior Bulbs
Front Low and High Beam Headlamp
Front Parking/Daytime Running Lamps
Front Fog Lamps
Front Side Marker Lamps
Front Turn Signal Lamps
Side Direction Lamps
Rear Turn Signal Lamps
Rear Side Marker Lamps
Bulb Number
HIR2LL
W21/5W
H11LL
W3W
WY21W
WY5W
PY21W
W3W
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 393
Rear Tail and Stop Lamps
Rear Backup Lamps
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp
License Plate Lamps
Bulb Number
P21/5W
W16W
W5W
LED (See Authorized dealer)
NOTE: Numbers refer to commercial bulb types that can be purchased from your authorized dealer.
If a bulb needs to be replaced, visit your authorized dealer or refer to the applicable Service Manual.
BULB REPLACEMENT
Headlamps Low Beam and High Beam
NOTE: Lens fogging can occur under certain atmo- 1. Remove the plastic cap from the back of the headlamp
spheric conditions. This will usually clear as atmospheric
housing.
conditions change to allow the condensation to change
2. Rotate the bulb counter-clockwise.
back into a vapor. Turning the lamps on will usually
accelerate the clearing process.
3. Remove the bulb and replace as needed.
4. Install the bulb and rotate clockwise to lock in place.
5. Reinstall the plastic cap.
7
394 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Front Turn Signal, Parking And Daytime Running
Lamps
3. Remove the plastic cap from the back of the lamp
housing.
1. Turn the steering wheel completely to the left or right. 4. Rotate bulb/socket counter-clockwise.
2. Open the wheel housing access door.
5. Remove the bulb and replace as needed.
6. Install the bulb into socket, and rotate bulb/socket
clockwise into lamp locking it in place.
7. Reinstall the plastic cap.
Front Fog Lamps
To replace the front fog lights, see your authorized dealer.
Wheel Housing Access Door
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 395
Front/Rear Side Marker Lamps
Rear Tail, Stop, Backup And Turn Signal Lamps
1. Remove portion of the wheel liner to allow hand 1. Open the liftgate.
access to side marker lamp.
2. Remove the two screws and remove the tail lamp
2. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise, and remove
assembly.
the bulb and socket assembly from the housing.
3. Pull the bulb from the socket and insert the replacement bulb.
4. Install the bulb and socket assembly into the housing,
and rotate the socket clockwise to lock it in place.
7
5. Reinstall the wheel liner.
Tail Lamp Assembly Screws
396 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Remove four screws and separate the backplate from 3. Disconnect the electric connector.
the lamp housing.
4. Press the retaining device and open the bulb holder.
4. Remove the tail, stop, or turn signal bulbs by pushing
5. Remove the snap-fitted bulb to be replaced and rethem slightly and turning counter-clockwise.
place it.
5. Remove the backup lamp bulb by pulling straight out.
6. Close the back cap locking it properly.
6. Replace lamps as required and reinstall lamp.
7. Reinstall the two fastening screws and reinstall the
guard caps.
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
1. Remove the two guard caps and the two fastening
screws.
2. Remove the center high mounted stop lamp assembly.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 397
FLUID CAPACITIES
Fuel (Approximate)
Engine Oil with Filter
1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine
Cooling System
1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine (MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine
Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula) — with
Manual Transmission
1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine (MOPAR® Antifreeze/Engine
Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula) — with Automatic Transmission
U.S.
10.5 Gallons
Metric
40 Liters
4 Quarts
3.8 Liters
4.6 Quarts
4.4 Liters
5.8 Quarts
5.5 Liters
7
398 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS, AND GENUINE PARTS
Engine
Component
Engine Coolant – 1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine
Engine Oil – 1.4L Engine
Engine Oil – 1.4L Turbo Engine
Engine Oil Filter – 1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine
Spark Plugs – 1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine
Fuel Selection – 1.4L/1.4L Turbo Engine
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/
150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology) meeting the requirements of FCA Material Standard MS.90032.
We recommend you use API Certified SAE 5W-30 Engine Oil,
meeting the requirements of FCA US Material Standard MS6395. Refer to your engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade.
Use API Certified SAE 5W-40 Full Synthetic Engine Oil, meeting
the requirements of FCA US Material Standard MS-12991. Refer
to your engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use a MOPAR® Engine Oil Filter.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs.
87 Octane Acceptable — 91 Octane Recommended.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 399
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) or any “globally compatible” coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, the cooling system will
need to be drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh
OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032), by an authorized dealer as soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
(Continued)
7
400 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Chassis
Component
Manual Transmission – If Equipped
Automatic Transmission – If Equipped
Brake Master Cylinder
Convertible Top Rails – If Equipped
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR® C635 DDCT/MTX
Transmission Fluid
Use only MOPAR® AW-1 Automatic Transmission Fluid
or equivalent. Failure to use the correct fluid may affect
the function or performance of your transmission.
We recommend you use MOPAR® DOT 3, SAE J1703
should be used. If DOT 3, SAE J1703 brake fluid is not
available, then DOT 4 is acceptable.
We recommend you use Berulub FR 43.
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
䡵 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
▫ Maintenance Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404
8
402 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic oil change
indicator system. The oil change indicator system will
remind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for
scheduled maintenance.
Based on engine operation conditions, the oil change
indicator message will illuminate. This means that service is required for your vehicle. Operating conditions
such as frequent short-trips, trailer tow, extremely hot or
cold ambient temperatures, and E85 fuel usage will
influence when the “Change Oil” or “Oil Change Required” message is displayed. Severe Operating Conditions can cause the change oil message to illuminate as
early as 3,500 miles (5,600 km) since last reset. Have your
vehicle serviced as soon as possible, within the next 500
miles (805 km).
Your authorized dealer will reset the oil change indicator
message after completing the scheduled oil change. If a
scheduled oil change is performed by someone other
than your authorized dealer, the message can be reset by
referring to the steps described under “Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your
Instrument Panel” for further information.
NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change intervals exceed 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or twelve months,
whichever comes first.
Severe Duty All Models
Change Engine Oil at 4,000 miles (6,500 km) if the vehicle
is operated in a dusty and off road environment. This
type of vehicle use is considered Severe Duty.
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 403
Once A Month Or Before A Long Trip:
Check engine oil level.
Check windshield washer fluid level.
Check the tire inflation pressures and look for unusual
wear or damage.
Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoir and brake
master cylinder, and fill as needed.
Check function of all interior and exterior lights.
Required Maintenance Intervals
Refer to the maintenance schedules on the following
page for the required maintenance intervals.
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
Change oil and filter.
Rotate the tires. Rotate at the first sign of irregular
wear, even if it occurs before the oil indicator system turns on.
Inspect battery and clean and tighten terminals as
required.
Inspect brake pads, rotors, and hoses.
Inspect engine cooling system protection and hoses.
Check and adjust hand brake.
Inspect exhaust system.
Inspect engine air cleaner if using in dusty or off-road
conditions.
8
404 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
Additional Inspections
Inspect the CV joints.
Inspect front suspension, tie rod
ends and boot seals, and replace if necessary.
Inspect the brake linings. Replace as necessary.
Inspect parking brake function.
Adjust as necessary.
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
Maintenance Chart
Refer to the Maintenance Schedules on the following pages for the required maintenance intervals.
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Additional Maintenance
Replace engine air filter.
Replace cabin air filter.
Clean and lube sun roof tracks.
Replace spark plugs (1.4L Engine). **
Replace spark plugs (1.4L Turbo
Engine). **
2
48,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 405
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
8
X
X
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
406 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
Flush and replace the engine
coolant at 10 years or 150,000
miles (240,000 km) whichever
comes first.
Inspect and replace PCV valve if
necessary.
Replace the timing belt.
** The spark plug change interval is mileage based only,
yearly intervals do not apply.
X
X
X
X
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 407
WARNING!
• You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you
have the knowledge and the right equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
• Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and
effect vehicle handling and performance. This
could cause an accident.
8
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
䡵 SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
䡵 WARRANTY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .413
YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
䡵 REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS . . . . . . . . . . . .413
▫ Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . .410
▫ In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C. . .413
▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414
▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
䡵 PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .414
䡵 IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
䡵 DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
▫ FIAT Customer Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
TIRE QUALITY GRADES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
▫ FIAT Canada Customer Center . . . . . . . . . . . .411
▫ Treadwear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
▫ Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
▫ Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .416
▫ Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
▫ Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .416
9
410 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.
At many authorized dealers, you may obtain a rental
vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it
is advisable to make these arrangements when you call
for an appointment.
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have
the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history. This can often provide a clue to the IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
current problem.
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally
Prepare A List
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy
Make a written list of your vehicle’s problems or the with our products and services.
specific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer.
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an
service advisor know.
authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and
are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality
service. The manufacturer’s authorized dealer have the
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 411
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and • Authorized dealer name
the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
correctly and in a timely manner.
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage
This is why you should always talk to an authorized
dealer service manager first. Most matters can be re- FIAT Customer Center
solved with this process.
P.O. Box 21–8004 Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004 Phone:
• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the 1-888-242-6342
general manager or owner of the authorized dealer. FIAT Canada Customer Center
They want to know if you need assistance.
P.O. Box 1621 Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6 Phone: 1-800• If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the con- 465-2001 (English) Phone: 1-800-387-9983 (French)
cern, you may contact the manufacturer’s customer
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
center.
Impaired (TDD/TTY)
Any communication to the manufacturer’s customer cenTo assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the
ter should include the following information:
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommuni• Owner’s name and address
cation Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer
• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)
center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who
9
412 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter manufacturer’s Service Contract National Customer
(TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call (800)
465-2001 English / (800) 387-9983 French).
manufacturer by dialing 1-800-380-CHRY.
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service
contract that is not the manufacturer’s service contract. It
is not responsible for any service contract other than the
manufacturer’s service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer’s service contract,
and you require service after the manufacturer’s New
Service Contract
Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle contract documents, and contact the person listed in
to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected those documents.
repairs after the manufacturer’s New Vehicle Limited
We appreciate that you have made a major investment
Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only
when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer
the manufacturer’s service contracts. If you purchased a has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and
manufacturer’s service contract, you will receive Plan training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with
Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their
within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related
have any questions about the service contract, call the concerns.
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require
assistance can use the special needs relay service offered
by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711
and for Voice callers, dial 1-800-855-0511 to connect with
a Bell Relay Service operator.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 413
WARNING!
Engine exhaust (internal combustion engines only),
some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and birth defects, or
other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids
contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain, or emit, chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer and birth defects,
or other reproductive harm.
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could
cause a crash or cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the
manufacturer.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in
a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
WARRANTY INFORMATION
individual problems between you, your authorized
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the dealer, and the manufacturer.
DVD, for the terms and provisions of FCA USA LLC To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety
warranties applicable to this vehicle and market.
Hotline toll free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424- 9153),
or go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., West
Building, Washington, D.C. 20590.
9
414 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
You can also obtain other information about motor NOTE: A street address is required when ordering
manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
Service Manuals
If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you
should contact the Customer Service Department immediately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety
defect to the Canadian government should contact Transport Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and
Recalls at 1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety/
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the information that students and professional technicians need in
diagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintaining, servicing, and repairing FCA USA LLC vehicles. A
complete working knowledge of the vehicle, system,
and/or components is written in straightforward language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals
To order the following manuals, you may use either the
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mastercard, American Express, and Discover orders are accepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call
for an order form.
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams,
charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals
make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix
problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and
features. They show exactly how to find and correct
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 415
problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshoot- DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
ing and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests TIRE QUALITY GRADES
and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
The following tire grading categories were established by
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The
Owner’s Manuals
specific grade rating assigned by the tire’s manufacturer
These Owner’s Manuals have been prepared with the in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on
assistance of service and engineering specialists to ac- your vehicle.
quaint you with specific FCA USA LLC vehicles. Included are starting, operating, emergency and mainte- All passenger car tires must conform to Federal safety
nance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities requirements in addition to these grades.
and safety tips.
Treadwear
• Call toll free at:
1-800-890-4038 (U.S.)
1-800-387-1143 (Canada)
Or
• Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
www.techauthority.com
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on
the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test course. For
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half
times as well on the government course as a tire graded
100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the
actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart
9
416 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
significantly from the norm due to variations in driving Temperature Grades
habits, service practices, and differences in road charac- The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
teristics and climate.
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under
Traction Grades
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the
and C. These grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and
grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction perforpassenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor
mance.
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test
WARNING!
wheel, than the minimum required by law.
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 417
WARNING!
The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure.
9
INDEX
10
420 INDEX
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .368
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Air Bag Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Air Bag Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Driver Knee Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Enhanced Accident Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Event Data Recorder (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Front Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
If A Deployment Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Knee Impact Bolsters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Maintaining Your Air Bag System . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Air Bag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Air Bag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51, 76, 143
Air Bag Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . .354
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
Air Conditioning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Air Conditioning Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
Air Conditioning, Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356, 357
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . .207, 209, 356
Air Pressure, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367, 397
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Automatic Dimming Mirror. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Automatic Oil Change Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .209
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229, 374, 376
INDEX 421
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375, 376
Fluid And Filter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Fluid Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Special Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Autostick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248, 371
Anti-Lock (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Brake/Transmission Interlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Bulb Replacement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392, 393
Bulbs, Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 392
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) . . . . . . . .18
Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398, 400
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .371
Capacities, Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . .397
Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Caps, Filler
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352, 353, 402
Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75, 296
Cargo Area Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Car Washes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
CD (Compact Disc) Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
10
422 INDEX
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Change Oil Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Check Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator Light) . .143,
347
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Checks, Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Child Restraints
Booster Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Child Seat Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seat Belt . . . . . . . .67
Infants And Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Install A LATCH-Compatible Child Restraint . . . .65
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Lower Anchors And Tethers For Children . . . . . . .61
Older Children And Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . .57
Seating Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Clean Air Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Cleaning
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
Clutch Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
Compact Disc (CD) Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Connector
UCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) . . . . . . . . . .203
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Convertible Top Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397, 398
Cooling System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .368
INDEX 423
Coolant Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366, 370
Disposal Of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
Drain, Flush, And Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370
Points To Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369, 370
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
Selection Of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .367
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376
Cruise Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Data Recorder, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Dealer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76, 208, 209
Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
Dipsticks
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Disposal
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Door Locks, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Downshifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Driving
Through Flowing, Rising, Or Shallow Standing
Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
Electric Remote Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Electronic Brake Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . .116
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) . . . . . .155
Exit Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
10
424 INDEX
New Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Start Of Trip Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Trip Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
Emergency, In Case Of
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . .347
Engine
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Checking Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .345, 346
Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75, 296
Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Flooded, Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293, 398
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350, 397
Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352, 353
Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351, 352, 398
Oil Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Enhanced Accident Response Feature. . . . . . . . .49, 339
Euro Twin Clutch Transmission
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75, 296
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75, 363
Exterior Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 392
Filters
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
Engine Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
INDEX 425
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Engine Oil Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Flashers
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 143
Flooded Engine Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Fluid, Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .400
Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Fluid Level Checks
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375
Fluids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
Fluids, Lubricants And Genuine Parts . . . . . . . . . . .398
Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111, 143
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Filler Cap (Gas Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Materials Added . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Octane Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
Tank Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397
Fueling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .385
Gas Cap (Fuel Filler Cap) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297, 299
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293, 397
Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293, 294
Gauges
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
Gear Select Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
10
426 INDEX
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
General Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350 Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382 Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Information Center, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140, 143
Hazard
Instrument Panel And Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, Or Shallow
Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240 Instrument Panel Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .381 Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .380
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
Heated Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Heated Seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207 Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
Hill Start Assist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251 Jack Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316, 321
Holder, Cup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
INDEX 427
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Key, Sentry (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Lap/Shoulder Belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293
Leaks, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Life Of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Liftgate (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Light Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 392
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 106
Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51, 76, 143
Anti-Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Brake Assist Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
Check Engine (Malfunction Indicator) . . . . . . . . .143
Engine Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107, 143
High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Low Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .393
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 108
Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . .143
Loading Vehicle
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
10
428 INDEX
Media Hub . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Locks
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Electric Powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
Lug Nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315 Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Monitor, Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Maintenance Free Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .355 Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Maintenance, General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350 New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Maintenance Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402 Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Malfunction Indicator Light (Check Engine). . . . . . .347 Octane Rating, Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414 Odometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226, 374
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374 Oil Change Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Frequency Of Fluid Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374 Oil Change Indicator, Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Lubricant Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374, 400 Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350, 397, 398
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .397, 398
Master Cylinder (Brakes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
INDEX 429
Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351
Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Filter Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Identification Logo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352
Materials Added To . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
Recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351, 352, 397
Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .352, 353
Oil Filter, Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
Operating Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347
Operator Manual (Owner’s Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Owner’s Manual (Operator Manual) . . . . . . . . . .5, 414
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Pets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Placard, Tire And Loading Information . . . . . . . . . .264
Power
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Outlet (Auxiliary Electrical Outlet) . . . . . . . . . . .128
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Pregnant Women And Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Preparation For Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Pretensioners
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Radio Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177, 206
Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376 Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Radio (Sound Systems) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
10
430 INDEX
Rear Liftgate (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Recorder, Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
Release, Hood. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
FCC General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Power Convertible Top Function . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Remote Sound System (Radio) Controls . . . . . . . . .204
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Replacement Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .349
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .413
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Restraints, Occupant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .413
Safety, Exhaust Gas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .402
Seat Belt
Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode . . . . . . .38
Energy Management Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Engage The Automatic Locking Mode . . . . . . . . .38
Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Seat Belt Pretensioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Seat Belt System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26
INDEX 431
Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28, 76
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28, 29, 32
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
SENTRY KEY®
FCC General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Sentry Key (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .410
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .414
Shift Lever Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Shift Speeds, Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29
Signals, Turn. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 108, 143
Snow Chains (Tire Chains) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275, 276
Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .398
Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . . . . . .116, 143
Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Cold Weather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Steering
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .242
10
432 INDEX
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Steering Wheel Audio Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Steering Wheel Mounted Sound System Controls . . .204
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .391
Storage, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Supplemental Restraint System - Air Bag . . . . . . . . .39
Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .353
Temperature Control, Automatic (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .209
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Tire And Loading Information Placard . . . . . . .263, 264
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78, 268, 415
Aging (Life Of Tires) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Life Of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263, 264
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Pressure Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257, 268
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .273
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
INDEX 433
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Tire Service Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
To Open Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Towing Vehicle Behind A Motorhome . . . . . . . . . . .299
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239, 240
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Transaxle
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229, 374
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
Transmitter Battery Service (Remote Keyless Entry) . .18
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Turn Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108, 143
UCI Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) Connector . . . .203
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292, 293
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Vehicle
Vehicle
Vehicle
Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264
Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Storage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216, 391
Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . . .143
Warnings And Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4, 413
Washer
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
10
434 INDEX
Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111, 114
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
Water
Driving Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Wheel And Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Wheel And Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .379
Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25, 127
Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24
Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76, 208, 209
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111, 114
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .360
INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING
EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this
vehicle’s electronic system to provide immunity to radio
frequency signals. Mobile two-way radios and telephone
equipment must be installed properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly
to the battery and fused as close to the battery as possible.
The negative power connection should be made to body
sheet metal adjacent to the negative battery connection.
This connection should not be fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the
roof or the rear area of the vehicle. Care should be used
in mounting antennas with magnet bases. Magnets may
affect the accuracy or operation of the compass on
vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and
routed away from the vehicle wiring when possible. Use
only fully shielded coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to
ensure a low Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than
normal may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications equipment and the
vehicle’s electronic systems.
2015 FIAT 500
2015
OWNER’S MANUAL
FCA US LLC
15FF500-126-AD
Fourth Edition Rev 1
Printed in U.S.A.
FIAT 500